1@c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 2@c This is part of the GCC manual. 3@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi. 4 5@node Target Macros 6@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions 7@cindex machine description macros 8@cindex target description macros 9@cindex macros, target description 10@cindex @file{tm.h} macros 11 12In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description 13includes a C header file conventionally given the name 14@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}. 15The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information 16about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the 17@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to 18@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes 19@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The 20source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure 21containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target 22machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions, 23if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called 24through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file. 25 26@menu 27* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable. 28* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes. 29* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}. 30* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information. 31* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data. 32* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types. 33* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers. 34* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers. 35* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much. 36* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros. 37* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function. 38* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called. 39* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands. 40* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work. 41* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code. 42* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations. 43* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler. 44* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections. 45* PIC:: Macros for position independent code. 46* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output. 47* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output. 48* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers. 49* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions. 50* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}. 51* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support. 52* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it. 53* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers. 54* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes. 55* D Language and ABI:: Controlling D ABI changes. 56* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces 57* Misc:: Everything else. 58@end menu 59 60@node Target Structure 61@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable 62@cindex target hooks 63@cindex target functions 64 65@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm 66The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable 67which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target 68machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h}; 69@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is 70used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers 71for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those 72macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example: 73@smallexample 74#include "target.h" 75#include "target-def.h" 76 77/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */ 78 79#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES 80#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes 81 82struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER; 83@end smallexample 84@end deftypevar 85 86Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to 87form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a 88``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future 89from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the 90@code{targetm} structure. 91 92Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are 93specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C 94Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the 95initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in 96@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm} 97themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in 98@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used. 99 100Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that 101are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper, 102documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in 103@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer 104@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in 105@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize 106@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set 107@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a 108default definition is used. 109 110Similarly, there is a @code{targetdm} variable for hooks that are 111specific to the D language front end, documented as ``D Target Hook''. 112This is declared in @file{d/d-target.h}, the initializer 113@code{TARGETDM_INITIALIZER} in @file{d/d-target-def.h}. If targets 114initialize @code{targetdm} themselves, they should set 115@code{target_has_targetdm=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default 116definition is used. 117 118@node Driver 119@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc} 120@cindex driver 121@cindex controlling the compilation driver 122 123@c prevent bad page break with this line 124You can control the compilation driver. 125 126@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS 127A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable 128initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces. 129 130The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading 131default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and 132choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It 133applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the 134options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options 135using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way. 136 137This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target 138options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so 139that the other specs are easier to write. 140 141Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 142@end defmac 143 144@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS 145A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@: 146@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer 147for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the 148outermost pair of surrounding braces. 149 150The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match 151the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec 152to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string 153@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default 154everywhere it occurs. 155 156The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading 157default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using 158the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}. 159 160Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 161@end defmac 162 163@defmac CPP_SPEC 164A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to 165pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you 166give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@. 167 168Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 169@end defmac 170 171@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC 172This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather 173than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of 174@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead. 175@end defmac 176 177@defmac CC1_SPEC 178A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to 179pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language 180front ends. 181It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options 182for GCC to pass to front ends. 183 184Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 185@end defmac 186 187@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC 188A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to 189pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you 190give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}. 191 192Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 193Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to 194@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of 195CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@. 196@end defmac 197 198@defmac ASM_SPEC 199A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to 200pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options 201you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler. 202See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this. 203 204Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 205@end defmac 206 207@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC 208A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to 209run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler. 210Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for 211an example of this. 212 213Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 214@end defmac 215 216@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT 217Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler 218an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to 219read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the 220output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any 221@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file. 222 223If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its 224standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler 225cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct; 226see @file{mips.h} for instance. 227@end defmac 228 229@defmac LINK_SPEC 230A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to 231pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you 232give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker. 233 234Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 235@end defmac 236 237@defmac LIB_SPEC 238Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference 239between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the 240command given to the linker. 241 242If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that 243loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}. 244@end defmac 245 246@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC 247Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program 248how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the 249linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after 250the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}. 251 252If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that 253passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker. 254@end defmac 255 256@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC 257By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the 258@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is 259instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a} 260depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static}, 261@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On 262targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define 263@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the 264driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command 265line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified. 266@end defmac 267 268@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED 269A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} 270mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be 271generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the 272shared @file{libgcc} in place of the 273static exception handler library, when linking without any of 274@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}. 275@end defmac 276 277@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC 278If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}. 279When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects 280the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in 281@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. 282@end defmac 283 284@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC 285Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The 286difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at 287the very beginning of the command given to the linker. 288 289If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the 290standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}. 291@end defmac 292 293@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC 294Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The 295difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at 296the very end of the command given to the linker. 297 298Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 299@end defmac 300 301@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC 302GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use. 303However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread 304models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define 305@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without 306blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the 307default value of this macro, will expand to the value of 308@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}. 309@end defmac 310 311@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC 312Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is 313configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib, 314et al, within sysroot+suffix. 315@end defmac 316 317@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC 318Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when 319GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the 320updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for 321usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix. 322@end defmac 323 324@defmac EXTRA_SPECS 325Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the 326@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like 327@code{CC1_SPEC}. 328 329The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures, 330containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a 331string constant that provides the specification. 332 333Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything. 334 335@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several 336related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar 337to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep 338these definitions. 339 340For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to 341define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is 342used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is 343used. 344 345The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines: 346 347@smallexample 348#define EXTRA_SPECS \ 349 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @}, 350 351#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT "" 352@end smallexample 353 354The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines: 355@smallexample 356#undef CPP_SPEC 357#define CPP_SPEC \ 358"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \ 359%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \ 360%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \ 361%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}" 362 363#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT 364#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV" 365@end smallexample 366 367while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines 368@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as: 369 370@smallexample 371#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT 372#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX" 373@end smallexample 374@end defmac 375 376@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1 377Define this macro if the driver program should find the library 378@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass 379the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search. 380@end defmac 381 382@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC 383The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker. 384By default this is @code{%G %L %G}. 385@end defmac 386 387@defmac POST_LINK_SPEC 388Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker. 389The default value of this macro is empty string. 390@end defmac 391 392@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC 393A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the 394linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a 395change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore, 396define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command 397line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish 398the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding 399@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead. 400@end defmac 401 402@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT 403True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker. 404@end deftypevr 405 406@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS 407Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of 408string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this 409target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using 410@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}. 411 412Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in 413the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in 414@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default. 415@xref{Target Fragment}. 416@end defmac 417 418@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR 419Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate 420a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix 421indicates an absolute file name. 422@end defmac 423 424@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX 425If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after 426@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched 427when the compiler is built as a cross 428compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it 429to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}. 430@end defmac 431 432@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX 433Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the 434standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to 435try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}. 436@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler 437is built as a cross compiler. 438@end defmac 439 440@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1 441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the 442standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix 443when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}. 444@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler 445is built as a cross compiler. 446@end defmac 447 448@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2 449Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the 450standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the 451default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}. 452@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler 453is built as a cross compiler. 454@end defmac 455 456@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX 457If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the 458standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the 459compiler is built as a cross compiler. 460@end defmac 461 462@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1 463If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the 464standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a 465cross compiler. 466@end defmac 467 468@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT 469Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment 470variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and 471loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to 472initialize the necessary environment variables. 473@end defmac 474 475@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR 476Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the 477standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to 478try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR} 479comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in 480@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order. 481 482Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its 483replacement. 484@end defmac 485 486@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT 487The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. 488See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components. 489If you do not define this macro, no component is used. 490@end defmac 491 492@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS 493Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path 494for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path 495usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}, 496@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and 497@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} 498and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile}, 499and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory 500@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs. 501 502The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures. 503Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a 504string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag 505for C++-only directories, 506and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be 507wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of 508the array with a null element. 509 510The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of, 511if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC} 512or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied 513operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}. 514 515For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS: 516 517@smallexample 518#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \ 519@{ \ 520 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \ 521 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \ 522 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \ 523 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \ 524 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \ 525@} 526@end smallexample 527@end defmac 528 529Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files: 530 531@enumerate 532@item 533Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}. 534 535@item 536The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} 537is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time 538@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed. 539 540@item 541The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}. 542 543@item 544The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed 545in the configured-time @var{prefix}. 546 547@item 548The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler. 549 550@item 551The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler. 552 553@item 554The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native 555compiler. 556@end enumerate 557 558Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles: 559 560@enumerate 561@item 562Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}. 563 564@item 565The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined 566value based on the installed toolchain location. 567 568@item 569The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH} 570(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this). 571 572@item 573The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed 574in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler. 575 576@item 577The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler. 578 579@item 580The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native 581compiler. 582 583@item 584The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a 585native compiler, or we have a target system root. 586 587@item 588The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a 589native compiler, or we have a target system root. 590 591@item 592The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications. 593If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and 594the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix. 595 596@item 597The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native 598compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is 599@file{/lib/}. 600 601@item 602The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native 603compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is 604@file{/usr/lib/}. 605@end enumerate 606 607@node Run-time Target 608@section Run-time Target Specification 609@cindex run-time target specification 610@cindex predefined macros 611@cindex target specifications 612 613@c prevent bad page break with this line 614Here are run-time target specifications. 615 616@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS () 617This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines 618built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using 619the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and 620@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end 621calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has 622finished command line option processing your code can use those 623results freely. 624 625@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the 626command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates 627the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form 628accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro. 629 630@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an 631object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace, 632@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it 633defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version 634with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original 635only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For 636example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__} 637and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips}, 638@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64} 639defines only @code{_ABI64}. 640 641You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable 642@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus} 643or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing 644assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like 645macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want 646to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the 647variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro 648@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional 649preprocessing. 650@end defmac 651 652@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS () 653Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional 654and is used for the target operating system instead. 655@end defmac 656 657@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS () 658Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional 659and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this 660macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define 661it yourself. 662@end defmac 663 664@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags 665This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before 666any target-specific headers. 667@end deftypevar 668 669@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS 670This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}. 671Its default setting is 0. 672@end deftypevr 673 674@cindex optional hardware or system features 675@cindex features, optional, in system conventions 676 677@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc}) 678This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the 679target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files 680(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific 681processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default 682definition does nothing but return true. 683 684@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and 685@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for 686storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the 687option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed 688via attributes). 689@end deftypefn 690 691@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value}) 692This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the 693target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt} 694definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some 695option-specific processing and should return true if the option is 696valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The 697default definition does nothing but return false. 698 699In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle 700options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are 701only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you 702should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead. 703@end deftypefn 704 705@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string}) 706Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one. 707@end deftypefn 708 709@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname}) 710Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU. 711@end deftypefn 712 713@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname}) 714Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU. 715@end deftypefn 716 717@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref}) 718If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object. 719@end deftypefn 720 721@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list}) 722If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type. 723@end deftypefn 724 725@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void) 726This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} 727but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or 728pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the 729attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation 730when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these 731actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call 732@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}. 733@end deftypefn 734 735@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS 736This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook 737but is only used in the C 738language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be 739used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those 740frontends. 741@end defmac 742 743@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE 744Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for 745various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes 746options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These 747options are processed once 748just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder 749of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other 750options passed explicitly. 751 752This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization 753options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the 754@code{optimize} attribute. 755@end deftypevr 756 757@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}) 758Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}. 759@end deftypefn 760 761@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void) 762Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}. 763@end deftypefn 764 765@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALIDATE_PARAM (int, @var{int}) 766Validate target-dependent value for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_param_value}. 767@end deftypefn 768 769@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET 770Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets 771during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for 772the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code 773can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16} 774and @code{nomips16} attributes. 775 776Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available 777registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various 778operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information 779in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a 780significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility 781for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly 782switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details. 783 784Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default 785is 0. 786@end defmac 787 788@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void) 789Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not. 790@end deftypefn 791 792@node Per-Function Data 793@section Defining data structures for per-function information. 794@cindex per-function data 795@cindex data structures 796 797If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC 798provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just 799using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports 800nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function 801when another one comes along. 802 803GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which 804contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This 805structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is 806@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point 807to their own specific data. 808 809If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type 810@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}. 811This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer 812@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below. 813 814One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an 815RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This 816RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address} 817function, for level 0. 818 819Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold 820all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested 821function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a 822stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the 823stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called 824@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle 825the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the 826single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no 827longer supported. 828 829@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS 830Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro 831is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun. 832The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the 833function pointer @code{init_machine_status}. 834@end defmac 835 836@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status 837If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per 838function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the 839target to perform any target specific initialization of the 840@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be 841used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure. 842 843@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@. 844Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using 845GC allocation, including the structure itself. 846@end deftypevar 847 848@node Storage Layout 849@section Storage Layout 850@cindex storage layout 851 852Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or 853alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C 854expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}. 855@xref{Run-time Target}. 856 857@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN 858Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a 859byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero. 860This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant 861bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still 862be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This 863macro need not be a constant. 864 865This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into 866bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}. 867@end defmac 868 869@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN 870Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a 871word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant. 872@end defmac 873 874@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN 875Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the 876most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both 877memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the 878order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This 879macro need not be a constant. 880@end defmac 881 882@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN 883On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between 884registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe 885the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls 886the order of words in memory. 887@end defmac 888 889@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN 890Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or 891@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word 892containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to 893have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant. 894 895You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for 896multi-word integers. 897@end defmac 898 899@defmac BITS_PER_WORD 900Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default 901is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}. 902@end defmac 903 904@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD 905Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is 906@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the 907largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time. 908@end defmac 909 910@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD 911Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose 912register, a power of two from 1 or 8. 913@end defmac 914 915@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD 916Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is 917@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the 918smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time. 919@end defmac 920 921@defmac POINTER_SIZE 922Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the 923width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode}, 924you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify 925a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. 926@end defmac 927 928@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED 929A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from 930@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is 931greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they 932should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion 933is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's 934@code{ptr_extend} instruction. 935 936You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode} 937and @code{word_mode} are all the same width. 938@end defmac 939 940@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type}) 941A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type 942is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be 943stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a 944scalar type. 945 946On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full 947register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if 948@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most 949cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision 950floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower 951counterparts. 952 953For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}. 954However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle 955either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on 956the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions 957sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set 958@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient. 959 960Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}. 961@end defmac 962 963@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type}) 964Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}. 965@end deftypefn 966 967@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return}) 968Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or 969function return values. The target hook should return the new mode 970and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should 971change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or 972pointer} types. 973 974@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and 975return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and 976@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here. 977If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in 978which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed; 979then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though 980the signedness may be different. 981 982@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls. 983 984The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can 985also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote} 986if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}. 987@end deftypefn 988 989@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY 990Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in 991bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment 992regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the 993size of an integer. 994@end defmac 995 996@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY 997Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the 998stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the 999desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default 1000if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines, 1001this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. 1002@end defmac 1003 1004@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY 1005Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the 1006stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition 1007is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This 1008macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than 1009@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}. 1010@end defmac 1011 1012@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY 1013Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different 1014from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate 1015to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}. 1016@end defmac 1017 1018@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY 1019Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits. 1020@end defmac 1021 1022@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT 1023Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in 1024bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported, 1025just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault. 1026@end defmac 1027 1028@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT 1029If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment 1030that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise, 1031@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used. 1032@end deftypevr 1033 1034@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT 1035Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to 1036provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. 1037@end defmac 1038 1039@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE 1040Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If 1041not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}. 1042@end defmac 1043 1044@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT 1045If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an 1046object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any 1047nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger 1048on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations. 1049@end defmac 1050 1051@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT 1052Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this 1053machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for 1054structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set 1055by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. 1056@end defmac 1057 1058@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{type}, @var{computed}) 1059An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} of 1060type @var{type} if the alignment computed in the usual way (including 1061applying of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the 1062alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the 1063field alignment has not been set by the 1064@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. Note that @var{field} 1065may be @code{NULL_TREE} in case we just query for the minimum alignment 1066of a field of type @var{type} in structure context. 1067@end defmac 1068 1069@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT 1070Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro 1071to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack. 1072 1073If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}. 1074 1075@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. 1076@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee 1077@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not 1078@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported. 1079@end defmac 1080 1081@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT 1082Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine. 1083Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the 1084@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct for functions and 1085objects with static storage duration. The alignment of automatic 1086objects may exceed the object file format maximum up to the maximum 1087supported by GCC. If not defined, the default value is 1088@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}. 1089 1090On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is 1091the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on 1092a 32-bit host e.g.@: @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}. 1093On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is 1094@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts. 1095@end defmac 1096 1097@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STATIC_RTX_ALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}) 1098This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for a 1099statically-allocated rtx, such as a constant pool entry. @var{mode} 1100is the mode of the rtx. The default implementation returns 1101@samp{GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}. 1102@end deftypefn 1103 1104@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align}) 1105If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in 1106the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is 1107the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this 1108macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object. 1109 1110If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used. 1111 1112@findex strcpy 1113One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to 1114make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character 1115arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy 1116constants to character arrays can be done inline. 1117@end defmac 1118 1119@defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align}) 1120Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates 1121some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@ 1122AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes 1123must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries. 1124 1125If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used. 1126@end defmac 1127 1128@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{constant}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{basic_align}) 1129This hook returns the alignment in bits of a constant that is being 1130placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and @var{basic_align} 1131is the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. 1132 1133The default definition just returns @var{basic_align}. 1134 1135The typical use of this hook is to increase alignment for string 1136constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy 1137constants can be done inline. The function 1138@code{constant_alignment_word_strings} provides such a definition. 1139@end deftypefn 1140 1141@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align}) 1142If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in 1143the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is 1144the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this 1145macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object. 1146 1147If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used. 1148 1149One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to 1150make it all fit in fewer cache lines. 1151 1152If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type. 1153@end defmac 1154 1155@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type}) 1156This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type 1157@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to 1158require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by 1159this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of 1160the vector element type. 1161@end deftypefn 1162 1163@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align}) 1164If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot. 1165@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available, 1166and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily 1167have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to 1168align the slot. 1169 1170If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when 1171@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will 1172be used. 1173 1174This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment 1175of all possible modes which the slot may have. 1176 1177If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type. 1178@end defmac 1179 1180@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl}) 1181If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local 1182variable @var{decl}. 1183 1184If this macro is not defined, then 1185@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))} 1186is used. 1187 1188One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to 1189make it all fit in fewer cache lines. 1190 1191If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type. 1192@end defmac 1193 1194@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align}) 1195If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment 1196for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl), 1197@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}. 1198 1199If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used. 1200@end defmac 1201 1202@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY 1203Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an 1204empty field such as @code{int : 0;}. 1205 1206If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro. 1207@end defmac 1208 1209@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY 1210Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of. 1211Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this. 1212 1213If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as 1214@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}. 1215@end defmac 1216 1217@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT 1218Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work 1219if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely 1220go slower in that case, define this macro as 0. 1221@end defmac 1222 1223@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS 1224Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle 1225alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them. 1226 1227The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int}, 1228@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire 1229structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of 1230that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so 1231that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it. 1232 1233Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as 1234@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force 1235four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may 1236not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.) 1237 1238An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing 1239structure. 1240 1241If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression; 1242a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior. 1243 1244Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some 1245bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can 1246support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and 1247@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory. 1248 1249The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define 1250@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}. 1251Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords. 1252 1253Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define 1254@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define 1255@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value. 1256 1257If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out 1258bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate 1259what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program: 1260 1261@smallexample 1262struct foo1 1263@{ 1264 char x; 1265 char :0; 1266 char y; 1267@}; 1268 1269struct foo2 1270@{ 1271 char x; 1272 int :0; 1273 char y; 1274@}; 1275 1276main () 1277@{ 1278 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n", 1279 sizeof (struct foo1)); 1280 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n", 1281 sizeof (struct foo2)); 1282 exit (0); 1283@} 1284@end smallexample 1285 1286If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would 1287get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}. 1288@end defmac 1289 1290@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED 1291Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited 1292to aligning a bit-field within the structure. 1293@end defmac 1294 1295@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void) 1296When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine 1297whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing 1298structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit 1299the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type. 1300@end deftypefn 1301 1302@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void) 1303This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields 1304should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if 1305these accesses should use the bitfield container type. 1306 1307The default is @code{false}. 1308@end deftypefn 1309 1310@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 1311Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should 1312be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}. 1313 1314If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its 1315mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the 1316case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to 1317retain the field's mode. 1318 1319Normally, this is not needed. 1320@end deftypefn 1321 1322@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified}) 1323Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given 1324by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual 1325way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was 1326@var{specified}. 1327 1328The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use 1329the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} 1330@end defmac 1331 1332@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE 1333An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer 1334machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of 1335this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the 1336appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE 1337(DImode)} is assumed. 1338@end defmac 1339 1340@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level}) 1341If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that 1342specifies the mode of the save area operand of a 1343@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}). 1344@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or 1345@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is 1346having its mode specified. 1347 1348You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You 1349would most commonly define this macro if the 1350@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a 135164-bit mode. 1352@end defmac 1353 1354@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE 1355If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that 1356specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an 1357@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}). 1358 1359You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}. 1360You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack} 1361pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode. 1362@end defmac 1363 1364@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void) 1365This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value 1366of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined 1367@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of 1368targets. 1369@end deftypefn 1370 1371@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void) 1372This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand 1373of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined 1374@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of 1375targets. 1376@end deftypefn 1377 1378@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void) 1379Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type. 1380The default is to use @code{word_mode}. 1381@end deftypefn 1382 1383@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type}) 1384This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given 1385@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft 1386Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage 1387unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have 1388different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest 1389alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous 1390bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of 1391the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that 1392(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows 1393another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true}, 1394other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored. 1395 1396When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size 1397of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent 1398bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record, 1399and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same 1400chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that 1401size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using 1402alignment, but not equivalent when packing. 1403 1404If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used, 1405the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is 1406used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take 1407precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure 1408may affect its placement. 1409@end deftypefn 1410 1411@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void) 1412Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point. 1413@end deftypefn 1414 1415@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void) 1416Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic. 1417@end deftypefn 1418 1419@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void) 1420This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target 1421to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion. 1422For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot 1423for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point 1424registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode 1425usage. 1426@end deftypefn 1427 1428@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void) 1429This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl 1430that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later. 1431@end deftypefn 1432 1433@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type}) 1434If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target 1435uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook 1436to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++ 1437mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing 1438the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are 1439not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL} 1440for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the 1441return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated 1442string constant. 1443 1444Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or 1445qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new 1446fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name} 1447is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the 1448length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of 1449ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where 1450@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code, 1451@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the 1452code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See 1453@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of 1454codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any 1455spaces in your string. 1456 1457This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled 1458name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you 1459can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT} 1460before mangling. 1461 1462The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is 1463appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental 1464types. 1465@end deftypefn 1466 1467@node Type Layout 1468@section Layout of Source Language Data Types 1469 1470These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard 1471basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in 1472the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related 1473languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout. 1474 1475@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE 1476A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the 1477target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word. 1478@end defmac 1479 1480@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE 1481A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the 1482target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word. 1483(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one 1484unit.) 1485@end defmac 1486 1487@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE 1488A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the 1489target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word. 1490@end defmac 1491 1492@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE 1493On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type 1494@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In 1495that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for 1496the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the 1497value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}. 1498@end defmac 1499 1500@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE 1501A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the 1502target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two 1503words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this 1504macro must be at least 64. 1505@end defmac 1506 1507@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE 1508A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the 1509target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1510@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}. 1511@end defmac 1512 1513@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE 1514A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and 1515C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define 1516this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. 1517@end defmac 1518 1519@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE 1520A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the 1521target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word. 1522@end defmac 1523 1524@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE 1525A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the 1526target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two 1527words. 1528@end defmac 1529 1530@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE 1531A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on 1532the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two 1533words. 1534@end defmac 1535 1536@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE 1537A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on 1538the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1539@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}. 1540@end defmac 1541 1542@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE 1543A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on 1544the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1545@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}. 1546@end defmac 1547 1548@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE 1549A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on 1550the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1551@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}. 1552@end defmac 1553 1554@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE 1555A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on 1556the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1557@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}. 1558@end defmac 1559 1560@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE 1561A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on 1562the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1563@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}. 1564@end defmac 1565 1566@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE 1567A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on 1568the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1569@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}. 1570@end defmac 1571 1572@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE 1573A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on 1574the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1575@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}. 1576@end defmac 1577 1578@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE 1579A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on 1580the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is 1581@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}. 1582@end defmac 1583 1584@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX 1585This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target 1586hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It 1587causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_} 1588prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which 1589uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in 1590the libgcc @file{config.host}. 1591@end defmac 1592 1593@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE 1594A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format 1595supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a 1596value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. 1597If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} 1598is the default. 1599@end defmac 1600 1601@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR 1602An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type 1603@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can 1604always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char} 1605and @option{-funsigned-char}. 1606@end defmac 1607 1608@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void) 1609This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an 1610@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range 1611of possible values of that type. It should return false if all 1612@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}. 1613 1614The default is to return false. 1615@end deftypefn 1616 1617@defmac SIZE_TYPE 1618A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use 1619for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the 1620contents of the string. 1621 1622The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with 1623spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if 1624appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one 1625of the data type names defined in the function 1626@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}. 1627You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the 1628compiler to crash on startup. 1629 1630If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned 1631int"}. 1632@end defmac 1633 1634@defmac SIZETYPE 1635GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype}, 1636@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions 1637dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing 1638the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype} 1639is extracted. 1640 1641The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string. 1642 1643If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}. 1644@end defmac 1645 1646@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE 1647A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use 1648for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name 1649@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See 1650@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information. 1651 1652If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}. 1653@end defmac 1654 1655@defmac WCHAR_TYPE 1656A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use 1657for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using 1658the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more 1659information. 1660 1661If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}. 1662@end defmac 1663 1664@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE 1665A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide 1666characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of 1667@code{WCHAR_TYPE}. 1668@end defmac 1669 1670@defmac WINT_TYPE 1671A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to 1672use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from 1673@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the 1674contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more 1675information. 1676 1677If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}. 1678@end defmac 1679 1680@defmac INTMAX_TYPE 1681A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that 1682can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type. 1683The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the 1684string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information. 1685 1686If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of 1687@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as 1688much precision as @code{long long int}. 1689@end defmac 1690 1691@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE 1692A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that 1693can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer 1694type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents 1695of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information. 1696 1697If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of 1698@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long 1699unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned 1700int}. 1701@end defmac 1702 1703@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE 1704@defmacx INT8_TYPE 1705@defmacx INT16_TYPE 1706@defmacx INT32_TYPE 1707@defmacx INT64_TYPE 1708@defmacx UINT8_TYPE 1709@defmacx UINT16_TYPE 1710@defmacx UINT32_TYPE 1711@defmacx UINT64_TYPE 1712@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE 1713@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE 1714@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE 1715@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE 1716@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE 1717@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE 1718@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE 1719@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE 1720@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE 1721@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE 1722@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE 1723@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE 1724@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE 1725@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE 1726@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE 1727@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE 1728@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE 1729@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE 1730C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t}, 1731@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t}, 1732@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t}, 1733@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t}, 1734@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t}, 1735@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t}, 1736@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t}, 1737@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t}, 1738@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See 1739@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information. 1740 1741If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding 1742type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide 1743@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform 1744to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of 1745these macros are null pointers. 1746@end defmac 1747 1748@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION 1749The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct 1750that looks like: 1751 1752@smallexample 1753 struct @{ 1754 union @{ 1755 void (*fn)(); 1756 ptrdiff_t vtable_index; 1757 @}; 1758 ptrdiff_t delta; 1759 @}; 1760@end smallexample 1761 1762@noindent 1763The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that 1764will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual. 1765Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must 1766always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can 1767distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some 1768platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In 1769that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift 1770the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left. 1771 1772GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store 1773this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform. 1774However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} 1775set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest 1776bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that 1777address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your 1778architecture, you should define this macro to 1779@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}. 1780 1781In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures 1782in which function addresses are always even, according to 1783@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to 1784@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}. 1785@end defmac 1786 1787@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS 1788Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This 1789macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors'' 1790instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a 1791function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the 1792data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data 1793pointer to which the function's data is relative. 1794 1795If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number 1796of words that the function descriptor occupies. 1797@end defmac 1798 1799@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN 1800By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment 1801is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies 1802the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only 1803when special alignment is necessary. */ 1804@end defmac 1805 1806@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE 1807There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below 1808zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment 1809specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number 1810of words in each data entry. 1811@end defmac 1812 1813@node Registers 1814@section Register Usage 1815@cindex register usage 1816 1817This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine 1818has, and how (in general) they can be used. 1819 1820The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is 1821done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information 1822on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}. 1823For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}. 1824For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}. 1825 1826@menu 1827* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers. 1828* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated. 1829* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold. 1830* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions. 1831* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387. 1832@end menu 1833 1834@node Register Basics 1835@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers 1836 1837@c prevent bad page break with this line 1838Registers have various characteristics. 1839 1840@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER 1841Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive 1842numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first 1843pseudo register's number really is assigned the number 1844@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}. 1845@end defmac 1846 1847@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS 1848@cindex fixed register 1849An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes 1850all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for 1851general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame 1852pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general 1853register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on 1854machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers, 1855and any other numbered register with a standard use. 1856 1857This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by 1858commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if 1859register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise. 1860 1861The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by 1862the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically, 1863by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by 1864the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}}, 1865@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}. 1866@end defmac 1867 1868@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS 1869@cindex call-used register 1870@cindex call-clobbered register 1871@cindex call-saved register 1872Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is 1873clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed 1874registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not 1875available for general allocation of values that must live across 1876function calls. 1877 1878If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler 1879automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function 1880exit, if the register is used within the function. 1881@end defmac 1882 1883@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS 1884@cindex call-used register 1885@cindex call-clobbered register 1886@cindex call-saved register 1887Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require 1888that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included. 1889(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}). 1890This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value 1891of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}. 1892@end defmac 1893 1894@cindex call-used register 1895@cindex call-clobbered register 1896@cindex call-saved register 1897@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 1898This hook should return true if @var{regno} is partly call-saved and 1899partly call-clobbered, and if a value of mode @var{mode} would be partly 1900clobbered by call instruction @var{insn}. If @var{insn} is NULL then it 1901should return true if any call could partly clobber the register. 1902For example, if the low 32 bits of @var{regno} are preserved across a call 1903but higher bits are clobbered, this hook should return true for a 64-bit 1904mode but false for a 32-bit mode. 1905 1906The default implementation returns false, which is correct 1907for targets that don't have partly call-clobbered registers. 1908@end deftypefn 1909 1910@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_REMOVE_EXTRA_CALL_PRESERVED_REGS (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, HARD_REG_SET *@var{used_regs}) 1911This hook removes registers from the set of call-clobbered registers 1912 in @var{used_regs} if, contrary to the default rules, something guarantees 1913 that @samp{insn} preserves those registers. For example, some targets 1914 support variant ABIs in which functions preserve more registers than 1915 normal functions would. Removing those extra registers from @var{used_regs} 1916 can lead to better register allocation. 1917 1918 The default implementation does nothing, which is always safe. 1919 Defining the hook is purely an optimization. 1920@end deftypefn 1921 1922@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_RETURN_CALL_WITH_MAX_CLOBBERS (rtx_insn *@var{call_1}, rtx_insn *@var{call_2}) 1923This hook returns a pointer to the call that partially clobbers the 1924most registers. If a platform supports multiple ABIs where the registers 1925that are partially clobbered may vary, this function compares two 1926calls and returns a pointer to the one that clobbers the most registers. 1927If both calls clobber the same registers, @var{call_1} must be returned. 1928 1929The registers clobbered in different ABIs must be a proper subset or 1930superset of all other ABIs. @var{call_1} must always be a call insn, 1931call_2 may be NULL or a call insn. 1932@end deftypefn 1933 1934@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_GET_MULTILIB_ABI_NAME (void) 1935This hook returns name of multilib ABI name. 1936@end deftypefn 1937 1938@findex fixed_regs 1939@findex call_used_regs 1940@findex global_regs 1941@findex reg_names 1942@findex reg_class_contents 1943@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void) 1944This hook may conditionally modify five variables 1945@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs}, 1946@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account 1947any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three 1948of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors). 1949@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and 1950@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is 1951called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, 1952@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized 1953from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, 1954@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively. 1955@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}}, 1956@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}} 1957command options have been applied. 1958 1959@cindex disabling certain registers 1960@cindex controlling register usage 1961If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target 1962flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify 1963@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the 1964registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make 1965@code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints 1966that shouldn't be used. 1967 1968(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all 1969of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are 1970controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using 1971these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.) 1972@end deftypefn 1973 1974@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out}) 1975Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C 1976expression returns the register number as seen by the called function 1977corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling 1978function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an 1979outbound register. 1980@end defmac 1981 1982@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in}) 1983Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C 1984expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function 1985corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called 1986function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound 1987register. 1988@end defmac 1989 1990@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno}) 1991Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C 1992expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the 1993register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers 1994need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local 1995gotos. 1996@end defmac 1997 1998@defmac PC_REGNUM 1999If the program counter has a register number, define this as that 2000register number. Otherwise, do not define it. 2001@end defmac 2002 2003@node Allocation Order 2004@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers 2005@cindex order of register allocation 2006@cindex register allocation order 2007 2008@c prevent bad page break with this line 2009Registers are allocated in order. 2010 2011@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER 2012If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the 2013numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer 2014to use them (from most preferred to least). 2015 2016If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first 2017(all else being equal). 2018 2019One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered 2020registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers 2021instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such 2022machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists 2023the highest numbered allocable register first. 2024@end defmac 2025 2026@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER 2027A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate 2028hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block. 2029 2030Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}. 2031Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next 2032register; and so on. 2033 2034The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of 2035@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro. 2036 2037On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro. 2038@end defmac 2039 2040@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER 2041Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the 2042prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from 2043using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA 2044allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some 2045call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this 2046macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0. 2047@end defmac 2048 2049@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno}) 2050In some case register allocation order is not enough for the 2051Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code. 2052If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value 2053based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will 2054be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the 2055value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent 2056to having it always return @code{0.0}. 2057 2058On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro. 2059@end defmac 2060 2061@node Values in Registers 2062@subsection How Values Fit in Registers 2063 2064This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values 2065(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many 2066consecutive registers are needed for a given mode. 2067 2068@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 2069This hook returns the number of consecutive hard registers, starting 2070at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode 2071@var{mode}. This hook must never return zero, even if a register 2072cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with 2073@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} and/or 2074@code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} instead. 2075 2076The default definition returns the number of words in @var{mode}. 2077@end deftypefn 2078 2079@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode}) 2080A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored 2081in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than 2082in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by 2083multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing 2084this mode by the number of registers returned by 2085@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero. 2086 2087For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit 2088registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be 2089nonzero. 2090 2091This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where 2092@code{subreg_get_info} 2093would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be 2094represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a 2095@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in 2096registers and so not be representable. 2097@end defmac 2098 2099@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode}) 2100For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which 2101@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression 2102returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value 2103including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four. 2104@end defmac 2105 2106@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode}) 2107Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values 2108of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that 2109should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is 2110used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This 2111happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of 2112floating-point registers is still 32-bit. 2113@end defmac 2114 2115@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 2116This hook returns true if it is permissible to store a value 2117of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several 2118registers starting with that one). The default definition returns true 2119unconditionally. 2120 2121You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers, 2122because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied. 2123 2124@cindex register pairs 2125On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd 2126register pairs. You can implement that by defining this hook to reject 2127odd register numbers for such modes. 2128 2129The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the 2130@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the 2131register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a 2132value into the register and back out not alter it. 2133 2134Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for 2135all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for 2136this hook to distinguish between these modes, provided you define 2137patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This is 2138useful because of the interaction between @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} 2139and @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer 2140modes to be tieable. 2141 2142Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic. 2143Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only 2144in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that 2145can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine 2146mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those 2147registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values. 2148 2149On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine 2150modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating 2151registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a 2152non-floating value there would garble it. In this case, 2153@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in 2154floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically 2155normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it 2156unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating 2157register, so you can define this hook to say so. 2158 2159The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that 2160they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic 2161instructions. However, this is of no concern to 2162@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper 2163constraints for those instructions. 2164 2165On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access, 2166so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a 2167register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the 2168floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not 2169be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one. 2170@end deftypefn 2171 2172@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to}) 2173A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register 2174@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}. 2175 2176One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to 2177another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt 2178handler. 2179 2180The default is always nonzero. 2181@end defmac 2182 2183@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}) 2184This hook returns true if a value of mode @var{mode1} is accessible 2185in mode @var{mode2} without copying. 2186 2187If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and 2188@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always 2189the same for any @var{r}, then 2190@code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})} 2191should be true. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define 2192this hook to return false unless some other mechanism ensures the 2193accessibility of the value in a narrower mode. 2194 2195You should define this hook to return true in as many cases as 2196possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register 2197allocation. The default definition returns true unconditionally. 2198@end deftypefn 2199 2200@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno}) 2201This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register 2202@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2. 2203 2204One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that 2205is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler. 2206 2207The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}. 2208@end deftypefn 2209 2210@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES 2211Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode} 2212registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from 2213@code{CCmode} is incomplete. 2214@end defmac 2215 2216@node Leaf Functions 2217@subsection Handling Leaf Functions 2218 2219@cindex leaf functions 2220@cindex functions, leaf 2221On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run 2222more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this 2223means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they 2224are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would 2225normally arrive. 2226 2227The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when 2228other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those 2229registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf 2230function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special 2231handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf 2232functions''. 2233 2234GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is 2235suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the 2236registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros 2237accomplish this. 2238 2239@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS 2240Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which 2241contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf 2242function treatment. 2243 2244If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the 2245registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that 2246GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be 2247used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1 2248in this vector. 2249 2250Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize 2251the treatment of leaf functions. 2252@end defmac 2253 2254@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno}) 2255A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno} 2256should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function. 2257 2258If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf 2259function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which 2260will cause the compiler to abort. 2261 2262Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the 2263treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do 2264this. 2265@end defmac 2266 2267@findex current_function_is_leaf 2268@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs 2269@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and 2270@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions 2271specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} 2272which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is 2273set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining 2274compiler passes. They can also test the C variable 2275@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf 2276functions which only use leaf registers. 2277@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes 2278that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if 2279@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined. 2280@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning 2281@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93 2282 2283@node Stack Registers 2284@subsection Registers That Form a Stack 2285 2286There are special features to handle computers where some of the 2287``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by 2288pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the 2289stack. 2290 2291Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and 2292they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing 2293support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating 2294point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses 2295stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on 2296@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate 2297with it, as well as defining these macros. 2298 2299@defmac STACK_REGS 2300Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers. 2301@end defmac 2302 2303@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS 2304This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if 2305the machine has any stack-like registers. 2306@end defmac 2307 2308@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG 2309The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top 2310of the stack. 2311@end defmac 2312 2313@defmac LAST_STACK_REG 2314The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of 2315the stack. 2316@end defmac 2317 2318@node Register Classes 2319@section Register Classes 2320@cindex register class definitions 2321@cindex class definitions, register 2322 2323On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent. 2324For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing; 2325certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine 2326restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}. 2327 2328You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying 2329which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes 2330that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns. 2331 2332@findex ALL_REGS 2333@findex NO_REGS 2334In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one 2335class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another 2336class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the 2337union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required. 2338 2339@findex GENERAL_REGS 2340One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing 2341terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters 2342@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is 2343the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands 2344to @code{ALL_REGS}. 2345 2346Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y} 2347then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}. 2348 2349The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand 2350constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters. 2351You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use 2352them in operand constraints. 2353 2354You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable 2355registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for 2356some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is 2357cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory 2358(@pxref{Costs}). 2359 2360You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some 2361instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows 2362either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a 2363certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS} 2364which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code, 2365or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the 2366class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}. 2367 2368You must also specify certain redundant information about the register 2369classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are 2370contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained 2371in their union. 2372 2373When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a 2374certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class. 2375Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for 2376a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to 2377specify this requirement is with @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. 2378 2379Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift 2380instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for 2381each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that 2382mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for 2383single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When 2384this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift 2385instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which 2386single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that 2387@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return. 2388 2389@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class} 2390An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names 2391as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS} 2392must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value, 2393@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather 2394tells how many classes there are. 2395 2396Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting 2397the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index 2398in many of the tables described below. 2399@end deftp 2400 2401@defmac N_REG_CLASSES 2402The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows: 2403 2404@smallexample 2405#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES 2406@end smallexample 2407@end defmac 2408 2409@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES 2410An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string 2411constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps. 2412@end defmac 2413 2414@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS 2415An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers 2416which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class 2417@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that 2418register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1. 2419 2420When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice. 2421Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing 2422several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer 2423for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}. 2424In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to 2425registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and 2426so on. 2427@end defmac 2428 2429@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno}) 2430A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register 2431@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class 2432which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the 2433register. 2434@end defmac 2435 2436@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS 2437A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid 2438base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address 2439which is the register value plus a displacement. 2440@end defmac 2441 2442@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}) 2443This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows 2444the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If 2445@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as 2446@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}. 2447@end defmac 2448 2449@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}) 2450A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid 2451base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index 2452register address. You should define this macro if base plus index 2453addresses have different requirements than other base register uses. 2454@end defmac 2455 2456@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code}) 2457A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid 2458base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address 2459space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} 2460define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is 2461the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level 2462of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an 2463@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding 2464index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. 2465@end defmac 2466 2467@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS 2468A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid 2469index register must belong. An index register is one used in an 2470address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or 2471added to another register (as well as added to a displacement). 2472@end defmac 2473 2474@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}) 2475A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is 2476suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses. 2477@end defmac 2478 2479@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}) 2480A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that 2481that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in 2482@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory 2483reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If 2484you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of 2485@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for 2486addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an 2487@code{address_operand}. 2488@end defmac 2489 2490@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}) 2491A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for 2492use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing 2493memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a 2494pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should 2495define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements 2496than other base register uses. 2497 2498Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general 2499@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. 2500@end defmac 2501 2502@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code}) 2503A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is 2504suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing 2505memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}. 2506This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except 2507that that expression may examine the context in which the register 2508appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the 2509immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the 2510address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an 2511@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the 2512corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; 2513@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses 2514that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}. 2515@end defmac 2516 2517@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num}) 2518A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is 2519suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be 2520either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been 2521allocated such a hard register. 2522 2523The difference between an index register and a base register is that 2524the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of 2525two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be 2526labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever 2527labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers 2528may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings, 2529looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers 2530only if neither labeling works. 2531@end defmac 2532 2533@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}) 2534A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced. 2535@end deftypefn 2536 2537@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}) 2538A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class 2539to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class 2540@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps 2541another, smaller class. 2542 2543The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument. 2544 2545Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For 2546example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range 2547for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always 2548@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers. 2549Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used. 2550 2551One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return 2552@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be 2553loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can 2554force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load 2555immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an 2556instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point 2557register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when 2558@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded 2559into any kind of register, code generation will be better if 2560@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead 2561of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}. 2562 2563If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go 2564through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} 2565to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes 2566reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses 2567this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in 2568the SSE registers (and vice versa). 2569@end deftypefn 2570 2571@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class}) 2572A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class 2573to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class 2574@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps 2575another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is 2576safe: 2577 2578@smallexample 2579#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS 2580@end smallexample 2581 2582Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For 2583example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range 2584for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always 2585@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers. 2586Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used. 2587 2588One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return 2589@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be 2590loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can 2591force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load 2592immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an 2593instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point 2594register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when 2595@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant cannot be loaded 2596into any kind of register, code generation will be better if 2597@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead 2598of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}. 2599 2600If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go 2601through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} 2602to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes 2603reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses 2604this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in 2605the SSE registers (and vice versa). 2606@end defmac 2607 2608@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}) 2609Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of 2610input reloads. 2611 2612The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} 2613argument. 2614 2615You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage 2616reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}. 2617@end deftypefn 2618 2619@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class}) 2620A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class 2621to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode 2622@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would 2623ordinarily be used. 2624 2625Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when 2626there are certain modes that simply cannot go in certain reload classes. 2627 2628The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another, 2629smaller class. 2630 2631Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which 2632require the macro to do something nontrivial. 2633@end defmac 2634 2635@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri}) 2636Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or 2637from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the 2638@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or 2639from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the 2640term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed 2641directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate 2642register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the 2643destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as 2644source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied, 2645reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register 2646and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the 2647intermediate register still holds the required value. 2648 2649Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which 2650allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch 2651register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic 2652address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC 2653when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode 2654as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than 2655that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to 2656describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register; 2657these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s) 2658of the scratch register(s). 2659 2660In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required. 2661 2662For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p}, 2663and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class 2664@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target 2665hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class} 2666needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}. 2667 2668If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires 2669an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should 2670return the register class required for this intermediate register. 2671If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS. 2672If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one 2673that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register. 2674 2675If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to 2676perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this 2677closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is 2678required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the 2679copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}. 2680 2681You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern 2682in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output 2683and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are 2684for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a 2685single-register-class 2686@c [later: or memory] 2687output constraint. 2688 2689When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload} 2690hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate 2691register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also 2692have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand. 2693 2694@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns - 2695@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers - 2696@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required 2697@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match 2698@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class 2699@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an 2700@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class. 2701@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.] 2702 2703 2704@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a 2705pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory. 2706Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is 2707in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register. 2708 2709Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are 2710currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue 2711to use @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose. 2712 2713@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are 2714copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate 2715(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost. 2716Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum 2717of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special 2718forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount. 2719@end deftypefn 2720 2721@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x}) 2722@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x}) 2723@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x}) 2724These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook 2725@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead. 2726 2727These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} 2728target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the 2729reload phase that it may 2730need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the 2731register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a 2732register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register, 2733you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the 2734largest register class all of whose registers can be used as 2735intermediate registers or scratch registers. 2736 2737If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an 2738intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} 2739was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register 2740class required. If the 2741requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro 2742@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both 2743macros identically. 2744 2745The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}. 2746Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x} 2747can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in 2748@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this 2749macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}. 2750 2751If a scratch register is required (either with or without an 2752intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for 2753@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required 2754(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally 2755implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the 2756@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch 2757register. 2758 2759These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch 2760register that 2761contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose 2762class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the 2763value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch 2764register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required. 2765Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern. 2766 2767@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a 2768pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory. 2769Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is 2770in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register. 2771 2772These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of 2773registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of 2774registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and 2775would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform 2776the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an 2777intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and 2778general registers. 2779@end defmac 2780 2781@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{class1}, reg_class_t @var{class2}) 2782Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied 2783to some other registers without using memory. Define this hook on 2784those machines to return true if objects of mode @var{m} in registers 2785of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of class @var{class2} by 2786 storing a register of @var{class1} into memory and loading that memory 2787location into a register of @var{class2}. The default definition returns 2788false for all inputs. 2789@end deftypefn 2790 2791@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode}) 2792Normally when @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler 2793allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies. 2794If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location 2795defined by this macro. 2796 2797Do not define this macro if you do not define 2798@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}. 2799@end defmac 2800 2801@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}) 2802If @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} tells the compiler to use memory 2803when moving between two particular registers of mode @var{mode}, 2804this hook specifies the mode that the memory should have. 2805 2806The default depends on @code{TARGET_LRA_P}. Without LRA, the default 2807is to use a word-sized mode for integral modes that are smaller than a 2808a word. This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures 2809that all bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the 2810registers in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for 2811floating-point registers. 2812 2813However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as 2814the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers 2815differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default 2816widening will not work correctly and you must define this hook to 2817suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.c} for 2818details. 2819 2820With LRA, the default is to use @var{mode} unmodified. 2821@end deftypefn 2822 2823@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SELECT_EARLY_REMAT_MODES (sbitmap @var{modes}) 2824On some targets, certain modes cannot be held in registers around a 2825standard ABI call and are relatively expensive to spill to the stack. 2826The early rematerialization pass can help in such cases by aggressively 2827recomputing values after calls, so that they don't need to be spilled. 2828 2829This hook returns the set of such modes by setting the associated bits 2830in @var{modes}. The default implementation selects no modes, which has 2831the effect of disabling the early rematerialization pass. 2832@end deftypefn 2833 2834@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass}) 2835A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned 2836to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because 2837registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers. 2838 2839The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass} 2840has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this 2841default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as 2842i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook 2843can be used to avoid excessive spilling. 2844 2845This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code 2846transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register 2847pressure. 2848@end deftypefn 2849 2850@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 2851A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers 2852of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}. 2853 2854This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. 2855In fact, the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass}, 2856@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of 2857@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} 2858values in the class @var{rclass}. 2859 2860This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values 2861in the reload pass. 2862 2863The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode} 2864in words. 2865@end deftypefn 2866 2867@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode}) 2868A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers 2869of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}. 2870 2871This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact, 2872the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})} 2873should be the maximum value of @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, 2874@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}. 2875 2876This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values 2877in the reload pass. 2878@end defmac 2879 2880@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (machine_mode @var{from}, machine_mode @var{to}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}) 2881This hook returns true if it is possible to bitcast values held in 2882registers of class @var{rclass} from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} 2883and if doing so preserves the low-order bits that are common to both modes. 2884The result is only meaningful if @var{rclass} has registers that can hold 2885both @code{from} and @code{to}. The default implementation returns true. 2886 2887As an example of when such bitcasting is invalid, loading 32-bit integer or 2888floating-point objects into floating-point registers on Alpha extends them 2889to 64 bits. Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 289032-bit object does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case 2891for a normal register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines 2892@code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} to return: 2893 2894@smallexample 2895(GET_MODE_SIZE (from) == GET_MODE_SIZE (to) 2896 || !reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, rclass)) 2897@end smallexample 2898 2899Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid, 2900if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{rclass} are wider 2901than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the 2902mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load 2903or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will 2904eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers. 2905Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the 2906entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial 2907value that the middle-end intended. 2908@end deftypefn 2909 2910@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t}) 2911A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from 2912 allocno and best class calculated by IRA. 2913 2914 The default version of this target hook always returns given class. 2915@end deftypefn 2916 2917@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void) 2918A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert. 2919@end deftypefn 2920 2921@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int) 2922A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero. 2923@end deftypefn 2924 2925@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void) 2926A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false. 2927@end deftypefn 2928 2929@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void) 2930A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false. 2931@end deftypefn 2932 2933@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst}) 2934A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't 2935substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during 2936register allocation. 2937The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}. 2938On most machines, this default should be used. For generally 2939machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such 2940as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling. 2941@end deftypefn 2942 2943@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{offset1}, rtx *@var{offset2}, poly_int64 @var{orig_offset}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 2944This hook tries to split address offset @var{orig_offset} into 2945two parts: one that should be added to the base address to create 2946a local anchor point, and an additional offset that can be applied 2947to the anchor to address a value of mode @var{mode}. The idea is that 2948the local anchor could be shared by other accesses to nearby locations. 2949 2950The hook returns true if it succeeds, storing the offset of the 2951anchor from the base in @var{offset1} and the offset of the final address 2952from the anchor in @var{offset2}. The default implementation returns false. 2953@end deftypefn 2954 2955@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode}) 2956This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs. 2957@end deftypefn 2958 2959@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t) 2960This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register class from all classes containing the same register set. In some complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs. 2961@end deftypefn 2962 2963@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode}) 2964This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns. 2965@end deftypefn 2966 2967@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes}) 2968A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}. 2969@end deftypefn 2970 2971@node Stack and Calling 2972@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions 2973@cindex calling conventions 2974 2975@c prevent bad page break with this line 2976This describes the stack layout and calling conventions. 2977 2978@menu 2979* Frame Layout:: 2980* Exception Handling:: 2981* Stack Checking:: 2982* Frame Registers:: 2983* Elimination:: 2984* Stack Arguments:: 2985* Register Arguments:: 2986* Scalar Return:: 2987* Aggregate Return:: 2988* Caller Saves:: 2989* Function Entry:: 2990* Profiling:: 2991* Tail Calls:: 2992* Shrink-wrapping separate components:: 2993* Stack Smashing Protection:: 2994* Miscellaneous Register Hooks:: 2995@end menu 2996 2997@node Frame Layout 2998@subsection Basic Stack Layout 2999@cindex stack frame layout 3000@cindex frame layout 3001 3002@c prevent bad page break with this line 3003Here is the basic stack layout. 3004 3005@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD 3006Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack 3007pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise. 3008@end defmac 3009 3010@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE 3011This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed 3012on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be 3013@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})} 3014 3015The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC}, 3016and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on 3017the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points 3018to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the 3019space for the next item on the stack. 3020 3021The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is 3022true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise, 3023which is often wrong. 3024@end defmac 3025 3026@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD 3027Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots 3028are at negative offsets from the frame pointer. 3029@end defmac 3030 3031@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD 3032Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing 3033addresses on the stack. 3034@end defmac 3035 3036@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET (void) 3037This hook returns the offset from the frame pointer to the first local 3038variable slot to be allocated. If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, it is the 3039offset to @emph{end} of the first slot allocated, otherwise it is the 3040offset to @emph{beginning} of the first slot allocated. The default 3041implementation returns 0. 3042@end deftypefn 3043 3044@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED 3045Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload. 3046The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports. 3047 3048On ports where @code{TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there 3049is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require 3050alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable 3051stack alignment and do it in the backend. 3052@end defmac 3053 3054@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET 3055Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which 3056outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of 3057zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines. 3058 3059If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above 3060the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed. 3061@end defmac 3062 3063@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl}) 3064Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's 3065address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the 3066function. 3067 3068If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above 3069the first argument's address. 3070@end defmac 3071 3072@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl}) 3073Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated 3074on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}. 3075 3076The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the 3077length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most 3078machines. See @file{function.c} for details. 3079@end defmac 3080 3081@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX 3082A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial 3083stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and 3084@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable 3085default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer 3086elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and 3087@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero. 3088@end defmac 3089 3090@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr}) 3091A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack 3092frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that 3093@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame 3094itself. 3095 3096If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value 3097of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the 3098address of the stack word that points to the previous frame. 3099@end defmac 3100 3101@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES 3102A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to 3103setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example, 3104on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack 3105before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to 3106define this macro. The default is to do nothing. 3107@end defmac 3108 3109@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void) 3110This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store 3111the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer. 3112The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most 3113machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if 3114@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine. 3115@end deftypefn 3116 3117@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr}) 3118A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame 3119address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer 3120of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address. 3121You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same 3122as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it. 3123@end defmac 3124 3125@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr}) 3126A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return 3127address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after 3128the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count} 3129frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if 3130@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero. 3131 3132The value of the expression must always be the correct address when 3133@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to 3134determine the return address of other frames. 3135@end defmac 3136 3137@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME 3138Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular 3139stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack 3140frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports. 3141@end defmac 3142 3143@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX 3144A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the 3145incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the 3146prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return 3147value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in 3148the stack. 3149 3150You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame 3151debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2. 3152 3153If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define 3154@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}. 3155@end defmac 3156 3157@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN 3158A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column 3159number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column 3160must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not 3161be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}). 3162 3163This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a 3164general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal 3165frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns 3166over time. 3167@end defmac 3168 3169@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG 3170A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register 3171number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should 3172only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and 3173someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to 3174terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this. 3175@end defmac 3176 3177@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index}) 3178This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that 3179contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging 3180info engine will invoke it on insns of the form 3181@smallexample 3182(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX)) 3183@end smallexample 3184and 3185@smallexample 3186(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)). 3187@end smallexample 3188to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is 3189the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of 3190the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}. 3191@end deftypefn 3192 3193@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_DWARF_POLY_INDETERMINATE_VALUE (unsigned int @var{i}, unsigned int *@var{factor}, int *@var{offset}) 3194Express the value of @code{poly_int} indeterminate @var{i} as a DWARF 3195expression, with @var{i} counting from 1. Return the number of a DWARF 3196register @var{R} and set @samp{*@var{factor}} and @samp{*@var{offset}} such 3197that the value of the indeterminate is: 3198@smallexample 3199value_of(@var{R}) / @var{factor} - @var{offset} 3200@end smallexample 3201 3202A target only needs to define this hook if it sets 3203@samp{NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS} to a value greater than 1. 3204@end deftypefn 3205 3206@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET 3207A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes, 3208from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack 3209frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of 3210the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the 3211previous frame, just before the call instruction. 3212 3213You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame 3214debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2. 3215@end defmac 3216 3217@defmac DEFAULT_INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET 3218Like @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}, but must be the same for all 3219functions of the same ABI, and when using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives 3220must also agree with the default CFI GAS emits. Define this macro 3221only if @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} can have different values 3222between different functions of the same ABI or when 3223@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} does not agree with GAS default CFI. 3224@end defmac 3225 3226@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl}) 3227A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes, 3228from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The 3229final value should coincide with that calculated by 3230@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable 3231during virtual register instantiation. 3232 3233The default value for this macro is 3234@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size}, 3235which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found 3236immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on 3237some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC 3238and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro. 3239 3240You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you 3241want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by 3242DWARF 2. 3243@end defmac 3244 3245@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl}) 3246If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset 3247in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). 3248The final value should coincide with that calculated by 3249@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. 3250 3251Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer, 3252via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is 3253variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is 3254defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be 3255based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one 3256of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} 3257should be defined. 3258@end defmac 3259 3260@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl}) 3261If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset 3262in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used 3263in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value 3264may reduce the size of debug information on some ports. 3265@end defmac 3266 3267@node Exception Handling 3268@subsection Exception Handling Support 3269@cindex exception handling 3270 3271@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N}) 3272A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for 3273data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than 3274@var{N} registers are usable. 3275 3276The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception 3277handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers 3278should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers, 3279but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least 32802 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers. 3281 3282You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception 3283handling like that provided by DWARF 2. 3284@end defmac 3285 3286@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX 3287A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which 3288to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return. 3289This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame. 3290It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally. 3291 3292Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise 3293untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot. 3294 3295Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored 3296by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in 3297this case, the exception handling library routines will update the 3298stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define 3299this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like 3300that provided by DWARF 2. 3301@end defmac 3302 3303@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX 3304A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which 3305to store the address of an exception handler to which we should 3306return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally. 3307 3308Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal 3309return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an 3310address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below 3311the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call 3312frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already 3313been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the 3314target call frame. 3315 3316Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an 3317address calculable during initial code generation. In that case 3318the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead. 3319 3320If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must 3321define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern. 3322@end defmac 3323 3324@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET 3325If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated 3326to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the 3327exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before 3328using it to return to the exception handler. 3329@end defmac 3330 3331@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global}) 3332This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception 3333handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such 3334that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations, 3335and so may be read-only. 3336 3337@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers. 3338@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations. 3339The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines 3340as found in @file{dwarf2.h}. 3341 3342If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but 3343represented directly. 3344@end defmac 3345 3346@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done}) 3347This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required 3348to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}. 3349Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must 3350be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings. 3351 3352This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was 3353handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number 3354of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF} 3355to be emitted. 3356@end defmac 3357 3358@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs}) 3359This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific 3360code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data 3361available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind 3362through signal frames. 3363 3364This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in 3365@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and 3366@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context}; 3367@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra} 3368for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for 3369the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register 3370save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should 3371evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded, 3372the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}. 3373 3374For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by 3375@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers. 3376@end defmac 3377 3378@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs}) 3379This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the 3380call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive, 3381usually used for signal or interrupt frames. 3382 3383This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's 3384@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context}; 3385@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi} 3386for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the 3387@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should 3388be updated in @var{fs}. 3389@end defmac 3390 3391@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO 3392A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind 3393info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat 3394linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}. 3395@end defmac 3396 3397@node Stack Checking 3398@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done 3399 3400GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the 3401stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of 3402three ways: 3403 3404@enumerate 3405@item 3406If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC 3407will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done 3408at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do 3409other special processing. 3410 3411@item 3412If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the 3413@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume 3414that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the 3415static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places 3416in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic 3417stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third 3418approach below. 3419 3420@item 3421If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically 3422``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below. 3423@end enumerate 3424 3425If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined, 3426GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option 3427@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated 3428dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes. 3429 3430@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN 3431A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a 3432machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking 3433is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack 3434checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default 3435value of this macro is zero. 3436@end defmac 3437 3438@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN 3439A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files 3440in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would 3441like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic 3442approach. The default value of this macro is zero. 3443@end defmac 3444 3445@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP 3446An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe 3447instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally 3448define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of 3449the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value 3450of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems. 3451@end defmac 3452 3453@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP 3454An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page 3455when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer 3456contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing 3457thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack 3458is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The 3459default value of this macro is zero. 3460@end defmac 3461 3462@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT 3463The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for 3464languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB 3465with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and 34668KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most 3467architectures and operating systems. 3468@end defmac 3469 3470The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN 3471nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether 3472in the opposite case. 3473 3474@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE 3475The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe 3476instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of 3477stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack 3478checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The 3479default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most 3480systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro. 3481@end defmac 3482 3483@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE 3484GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It 3485represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including 3486space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables. 3487You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally 3488use the default of four words. 3489@end defmac 3490 3491@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE 3492The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the 3493fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies 3494@option{-fstack-check}. 3495GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will 3496normally not need to override that default. 3497@end defmac 3498 3499@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STACK_CLASH_PROTECTION_ALLOCA_PROBE_RANGE (void) 3500Some targets have an ABI defined interval for which no probing needs to be done. 3501When a probe does need to be done this same interval is used as the probe distance up when doing stack clash protection for alloca. 3502On such targets this value can be set to override the default probing up interval. 3503Define this variable to return nonzero if such a probe range is required or zero otherwise. Defining this hook also requires your functions which make use of alloca to have at least 8 byesof outgoing arguments. If this is not the case the stack will be corrupted. 3504You need not define this macro if it would always have the value zero. 3505@end deftypefn 3506 3507@need 2000 3508@node Frame Registers 3509@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame 3510 3511@c prevent bad page break with this line 3512This discusses registers that address the stack frame. 3513 3514@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM 3515The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a 3516fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines, 3517the hardware determines which register this is. 3518@end defmac 3519 3520@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM 3521The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to 3522access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the 3523hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can 3524choose any register you wish for this purpose. 3525@end defmac 3526 3527@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM 3528On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting 3529offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register 3530allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are 3531between these two locations). On those machines, define 3532@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to 3533be used internally until the offset is known, and define 3534@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number 3535used for the frame pointer. 3536 3537You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it 3538is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and 3539the automatic variables until after register allocation has been 3540completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your 3541definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate 3542@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} 3543or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}. 3544 3545Do not define this macro if it would be the same as 3546@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}. 3547@end defmac 3548 3549@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM 3550The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access 3551the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the 3552frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which 3553register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you 3554wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame 3555pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to 3556@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it 3557(@pxref{Elimination}). 3558@end defmac 3559 3560@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER 3561Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if 3562@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be 3563the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM 3564== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that 3565definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals. 3566@end defmac 3567 3568@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER 3569Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if 3570@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the 3571same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM == 3572ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that 3573definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals. 3574@end defmac 3575 3576@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM 3577The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to 3578access the current function's return address from the stack. On some 3579machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame 3580pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined 3581to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by 3582@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer. 3583 3584Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return 3585address from the stack. 3586@end defmac 3587 3588@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM 3589@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM 3590Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If 3591register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called 3592function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register 3593number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If 3594these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need 3595not be defined. 3596 3597The static chain register need not be a fixed register. 3598 3599If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be 3600defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used. 3601@end defmac 3602 3603@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p}) 3604This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for 3605targets that may use different static chain locations for different 3606nested functions. This may be required if the target has function 3607attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and 3608those calling conventions use different static chain locations. 3609 3610The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al. 3611 3612If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to 3613provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored. 3614Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset 3615from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee 3616will be at an offset from the frame pointer. 3617@findex stack_pointer_rtx 3618@findex frame_pointer_rtx 3619@findex arg_pointer_rtx 3620The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and 3621@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used 3622to refer to those items. 3623@end deftypefn 3624 3625@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS 3626This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be 3627saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in 3628DWARF2 exception handling. 3629 3630Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable 3631exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA 3632extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes 3633in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be 3634used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling 3635routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of 3636registers that are not call-saved. 3637 3638If this macro is not defined, it defaults to 3639@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}. 3640@end defmac 3641 3642@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS 3643 3644This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided 3645for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code. 3646 3647If this macro is not defined, it defaults to 3648@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}. 3649@end defmac 3650 3651@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno}) 3652 3653Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers 3654is different than the internal representation for unwind column. 3655Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind 3656column number to use instead. 3657@end defmac 3658 3659@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno}) 3660 3661Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers 3662used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other 3663debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro 3664should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is 3665@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}. 3666 3667@end defmac 3668 3669@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh}) 3670 3671Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info 3672that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that 3673should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and 3674.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to 3675return @code{@var{regno}}. 3676 3677@end defmac 3678 3679@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT 3680 3681Define this macro if the target stores register values as 3682@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if 3683target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The 3684default is to store register values as @code{void *} type. 3685 3686@end defmac 3687 3688@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT 3689 3690Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind 3691context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined, 3692it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is 3693defined and 0 otherwise. 3694 3695@end defmac 3696 3697@defmac DWARF_LAZY_REGISTER_VALUE (@var{regno}, @var{value}) 3698Define this macro if the target has pseudo DWARF registers whose 3699values need to be computed lazily on demand by the unwinder (such as when 3700referenced in a CFA expression). The macro returns true if @var{regno} 3701is such a register and stores its value in @samp{*@var{value}} if so. 3702@end defmac 3703 3704@node Elimination 3705@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer 3706 3707@c prevent bad page break with this line 3708This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer. 3709 3710@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void) 3711This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use 3712a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return 3713value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer. 3714 3715This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide 3716according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the 3717constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code 3718to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. 3719Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame 3720pointer. 3721 3722In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code 3723without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and 3724automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what 3725@code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about 3726them. 3727 3728In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer 3729register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a 3730fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information. 3731 3732Default return value is @code{false}. 3733@end deftypefn 3734 3735@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS 3736This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate 3737unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. 3738 3739The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each 3740of which specifies an original and replacement register. 3741 3742On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until 3743the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register 3744must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by 3745replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer, 3746depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated. 3747 3748In this case, you might specify: 3749@smallexample 3750#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \ 3751@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \ 3752 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \ 3753 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@} 3754@end smallexample 3755 3756Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is 3757specified first since that is the preferred elimination. 3758@end defmac 3759 3760@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg}) 3761This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to 3762try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number 3763@var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the 3764cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already 3765knows about. 3766 3767Default return value is @code{true}. 3768@end deftypefn 3769 3770@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var}) 3771This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair 3772of registers. The value would be computed from information 3773such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of 3774registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}. 3775@end defmac 3776 3777@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_COMPUTE_FRAME_LAYOUT (void) 3778This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be 3779recalculated. The calculations can be cached by the target and can then 3780be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the 3781layout on every invocation of that hook. This is particularly useful 3782for targets that have an expensive frame layout function. Implementing 3783this callback is optional. 3784@end deftypefn 3785 3786@node Stack Arguments 3787@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack 3788@cindex arguments on stack 3789@cindex stack arguments 3790 3791The macros in this section control how arguments are passed 3792on the stack. See the following section for other macros that 3793control passing certain arguments in registers. 3794 3795@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype}) 3796This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a 3797prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be 3798passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain 3799cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines. 3800The default is to not promote prototypes. 3801@end deftypefn 3802 3803@defmac PUSH_ARGS 3804A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass 3805outgoing arguments. 3806If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero. 3807That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to 3808allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into 3809it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too. 3810@end defmac 3811 3812@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED 3813A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from 3814last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not 3815defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack 3816and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise. 3817@end defmac 3818 3819@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed}) 3820A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the 3821stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes. 3822 3823On some machines, the definition 3824 3825@smallexample 3826#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES) 3827@end smallexample 3828 3829@noindent 3830will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear 3831to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain 3832alignment. Then the definition should be 3833 3834@smallexample 3835#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1) 3836@end smallexample 3837 3838If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type. 3839@end defmac 3840 3841@findex outgoing_args_size 3842@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size 3843@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS 3844A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments 3845will be computed and placed into 3846@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed 3847onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should 3848increase the stack frame size by this amount. 3849 3850Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} 3851is not proper. 3852@end defmac 3853 3854@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl}) 3855Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been 3856allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in 3857registers. 3858 3859The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for 3860arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl}, 3861which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function. 3862The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself 3863of the function. 3864 3865This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the 3866machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says 3867which. 3868@end defmac 3869@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did 3870@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93 3871 3872@defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl}) 3873Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments. 3874Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body 3875is different to space required when making a call, a situation that 3876can arise with K&R style function definitions. 3877@end defmac 3878 3879@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype}) 3880Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the 3881caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers 3882when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL 3883if the function called is a library function. 3884 3885If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls 3886whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of 3887@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. 3888@end defmac 3889 3890@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA 3891Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the 3892stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it. 3893@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the 3894@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93 3895 3896Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the 3897stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro 3898suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the 3899stack in its natural location. 3900@end defmac 3901 3902@deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_int64 TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, poly_int64 @var{size}) 3903This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that 3904a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments 3905and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns. 3906 3907@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes 3908the function in question. Normally it is a node of type 3909@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function. 3910From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function. 3911 3912@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that 3913describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type 3914@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function. 3915From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and 3916arguments (if known). 3917 3918When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl} 3919will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if 3920you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so 3921by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means 3922a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially 3923in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled. 3924 3925@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the 3926stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and 3927argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function. 3928 3929On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition 3930of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard 3931calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of 3932the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling 3933convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of 3934arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop 3935nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use, 3936@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed 3937number of arguments. 3938@end deftypefn 3939 3940@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum}) 3941A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence 3942pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} 3943when compiling a function call. 3944 3945@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function 3946have been accumulated. 3947 3948On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used 3949that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments 3950that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the 3951call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not 3952appropriate. 3953@end defmac 3954 3955@node Register Arguments 3956@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers 3957@cindex arguments in registers 3958@cindex registers arguments 3959 3960This section describes the macros which let you control how various 3961types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in 3962the stack. 3963 3964@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named}) 3965Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a 3966register and if so, which register. 3967 3968The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous 3969arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type}, 3970the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known 3971(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named}, 3972which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for 3973nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called 3974function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a 3975syntax error has previously occurred. 3976 3977The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard 3978register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument 3979on the stack. 3980 3981The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is 3982passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks 3983should be used to store or load argument in such case. See 3984@code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} 3985for more information. 3986 3987The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is 3988used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the 3989@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The 3990@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one 3991describes where part of the argument is passed. In each 3992@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard 3993register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the 3994register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The 3995second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives 3996the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts. 3997As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel} 3998RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire 3999argument is also stored on the stack. 4000 4001The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE == 4002VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value} 4003pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively. 4004 4005@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments 4006The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a 4007machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to 4008cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is 4009done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever 4010@var{named} is @code{false}. 4011 4012@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} 4013@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} 4014You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack} 4015in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a 4016type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} 4017is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an 4018argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is 4019defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into 4020a register. 4021@end deftypefn 4022 4023@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}) 4024This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type} 4025solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a 4026definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional 4027documentation. 4028@end deftypefn 4029 4030@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named}) 4031Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different 4032views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are 4033functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware 4034and which have nonstandard calling conventions. 4035 4036In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in 4037which the caller passes the value, and 4038@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar 4039fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will 4040arrive. 4041 4042@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address 4043computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register, 4044so that it can be used to pass special arguments. 4045 4046If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, 4047@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes. 4048@end deftypefn 4049 4050@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void) 4051This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created 4052for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand. 4053@end deftypefn 4054 4055@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void) 4056Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx. 4057This hook is called at the start of register allocation. 4058@end deftypefn 4059 4060@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named}) 4061This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an 4062argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for 4063arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely 4064pushed on the stack. 4065 4066On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in 4067registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the 4068first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest 4069on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a 4070structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed 4071in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the 4072compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers. 4073 4074@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first 4075register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise 4076@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function. 4077@end deftypefn 4078 4079@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named}) 4080This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the 4081position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This 4082predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being 4083passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}. 4084 4085If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a 4086pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself. 4087The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer 4088to that type. 4089@end deftypefn 4090 4091@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named}) 4092The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is 4093known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the 4094function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied 4095by the caller. 4096 4097For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be 4098determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need 4099not be generated. 4100 4101The default version of this hook always returns false. 4102@end deftypefn 4103 4104@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS 4105A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument 4106of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some 4107target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number 4108of bytes of argument so far. 4109 4110There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the 4111arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other 4112variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all 4113arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in 4114@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and 4115should not be empty, so use @code{int}. 4116@end defmac 4117 4118@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl}) 4119If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a 4120function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been 4121created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to 4122reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default. 4123If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function, 4124@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}. 4125@end defmac 4126 4127@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args}) 4128A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable 4129@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The 4130variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype} 4131is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive 4132the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function. 4133For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the 4134declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when 4135@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function 4136being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named 4137arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a 4138parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments, 4139@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1. 4140 4141When processing a call to a compiler support library function, 4142@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which 4143contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when 4144an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this 4145macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but 4146never both of them at once. 4147@end defmac 4148 4149@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname}) 4150Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls, 4151it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be 4152@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro 4153is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname, 41540)} is used instead. 4155@end defmac 4156 4157@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}) 4158Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of 4159finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is 4160undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead. 4161 4162The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines 4163with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The 4164argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with 4165@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. 4166@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe. 4167@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93 4168@end defmac 4169 4170@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named}) 4171This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to 4172advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode}, 4173@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done, 4174the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following} 4175argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc. 4176 4177This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed 4178on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space 4179used for arguments without any special help. 4180@end deftypefn 4181 4182@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}) 4183This hook returns the number of bytes to add to the offset of an 4184argument of type @var{type} and mode @var{mode} when passed in memory. 4185This is needed for the SPU, which passes @code{char} and @code{short} 4186arguments in the preferred slot that is in the middle of the quad word 4187instead of starting at the top. The default implementation returns 0. 4188@end deftypefn 4189 4190@deftypefn {Target Hook} pad_direction TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}) 4191This hook determines whether, and in which direction, to pad out 4192an argument of mode @var{mode} and type @var{type}. It returns 4193@code{PAD_UPWARD} to insert padding above the argument, @code{PAD_DOWNWARD} 4194to insert padding below the argument, or @code{PAD_NONE} to inhibit padding. 4195 4196The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this hook, but by 4197@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is always just enough 4198to reach the next multiple of that boundary. 4199 4200This hook has a default definition that is right for most systems. 4201For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For 4202big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of 4203constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise. 4204@end deftypefn 4205 4206@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN 4207If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default 4208implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the 4209next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as 4210controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such 4211arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true. 4212@end defmac 4213 4214@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first}) 4215Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and 4216memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this 4217macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian 4218machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular, 4219@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in 4220registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example, 4221a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so 4222required. 4223@end defmac 4224 4225@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}) 4226This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument 4227with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns 4228@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments. 4229@end deftypefn 4230 4231@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}) 4232Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}, 4233which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to 4234return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger 4235value. 4236@end deftypefn 4237 4238@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno}) 4239A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard 4240register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does 4241@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and 4242the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be 4243used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the 4244stack. 4245@end defmac 4246 4247@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type}) 4248This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed 4249as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex 4250arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments 4251to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on 4252AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point 4253registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating 4254point register. 4255 4256The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always 4257false. 4258@end deftypefn 4259 4260@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void) 4261This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target. 4262The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}. 4263@end deftypefn 4264 4265@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree}) 4266This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} 4267to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The 4268variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer 4269to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed 4270variable. 4271The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of 4272this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its 4273internal type. 4274If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element. 4275Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this 4276macro to iterate through all types. 4277@end deftypefn 4278 4279@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl}) 4280This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by 4281@var{fndecl}. 4282The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}. 4283@end deftypefn 4284 4285@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type}) 4286This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the 4287type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns 4288@code{NULL_TREE}. 4289@end deftypefn 4290 4291@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p}) 4292This hook performs target-specific gimplification of 4293@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the 4294arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in 4295@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}. 4296@end deftypefn 4297 4298@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}) 4299Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers 4300with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this 4301hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}. 4302@end deftypefn 4303 4304@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref}) 4305Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int. 4306@end deftypefn 4307 4308@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_TRANSLATE_MODE_ATTRIBUTE (machine_mode @var{mode}) 4309Define this hook if during mode attribute processing, the port should 4310translate machine_mode @var{mode} to another mode. For example, rs6000's 4311@code{KFmode}, when it is the same as @code{TFmode}. 4312 4313The default version of the hook returns that mode that was passed in. 4314@end deftypefn 4315 4316@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_mode @var{mode}) 4317Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle 4318insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be 4319considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons 4320must work. 4321 4322The default version of this hook returns true for any mode 4323required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port). 4324Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the 4325code in @file{optabs.c}. 4326@end deftypefn 4327 4328@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}) 4329Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle 4330insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it 4331must have move patterns for this mode. 4332@end deftypefn 4333 4334@deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_ARRAY_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems}) 4335Return the mode that GCC should use for an array that has 4336@var{nelems} elements, with each element having mode @var{mode}. 4337Return no mode if the target has no special requirements. In the 4338latter case, GCC looks for an integer mode of the appropriate size 4339if available and uses BLKmode otherwise. Usually the search for the 4340integer mode is limited to @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE}, but the 4341@code{TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} hook allows a larger mode to be 4342used in specific cases. 4343 4344The main use of this hook is to specify that an array of vectors should 4345also have a vector mode. The default implementation returns no mode. 4346@end deftypefn 4347 4348@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems}) 4349Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array 4350of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}. 4351Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit 4352and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode. 4353 4354One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations 4355that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON 4356has operations like: 4357 4358@smallexample 4359int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *) 4360@end smallexample 4361 4362where the return type is defined as: 4363 4364@smallexample 4365typedef struct int8x8x3_t 4366@{ 4367 int8x8_t val[3]; 4368@} int8x8x3_t; 4369@end smallexample 4370 4371If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then 4372@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store 4373@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack. 4374@end deftypefn 4375 4376@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_float_mode @var{mode}) 4377Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the 4378floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass 4379@code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this 4380hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, 4381@code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist. 4382@end deftypefn 4383 4384@deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_scalar_float_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended}) 4385Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type 4386@code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type 4387@code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type is not 4388supported, return @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The default version of 4389this hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for 4390@code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for 4391@code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for 4392those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and 4393@code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it 4394returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and 4395satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns 4396@code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The hook is only called for values 4397of @var{n} and @var{extended} that are valid according to 4398ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or, 4399if @var{extended} is false, 16 or greater than 128 and a multiple of 32. 4400@end deftypefn 4401 4402@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOATN_BUILTIN_P (int @var{func}) 4403Define this to return true if the @code{_Float@var{n}} and 4404@code{_Float@var{n}x} built-in functions should implicitly enable the 4405built-in function without the @code{__builtin_} prefix in addition to the 4406normal built-in function with the @code{__builtin_} prefix. The default is 4407to only enable built-in functions without the @code{__builtin_} prefix for 4408the GNU C langauge. In strict ANSI/ISO mode, the built-in function without 4409the @code{__builtin_} prefix is not enabled. The argument @code{FUNC} is the 4410@code{enum built_in_function} id of the function to be enabled. 4411@end deftypefn 4412 4413@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode}) 4414Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has 4415small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given 4416@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers 4417in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument. 4418In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero 4419for any mode. 4420 4421On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary 4422insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values 4423to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail 4424if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an 4425insn. 4426 4427Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used 4428in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in 4429the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register 4430classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point 4431registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific 4432registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many 4433SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good 4434strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P} 4435machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes. 4436 4437The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always 4438safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you 4439unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations 4440that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook 4441to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out 4442of spill registers and print a fatal error message. 4443@end deftypefn 4444 4445@node Scalar Return 4446@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned 4447@cindex return values in registers 4448@cindex values, returned by functions 4449@cindex scalars, returned as values 4450 4451This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as 4452values---values that can fit in registers. 4453 4454@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing}) 4455 4456Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function 4457returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node 4458representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node 4459representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a 4460function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should 4461compute the register in which the caller will see the return value. 4462Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where 4463a function returns a value. 4464 4465On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant. 4466(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same 4467place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a 4468@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored. 4469The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in 4470multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the 4471@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every 4472location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of 4473the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use 4474that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k 4475port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both 4476@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}. 4477 4478If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply 4479the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if 4480@var{valtype} is a scalar type. 4481 4482If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree 4483node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null 4484pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning 4485convention for specific functions when all their calls are 4486known. 4487 4488Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in 4489which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which 4490the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return 4491different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}. 4492 4493@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with 4494aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See 4495@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below. 4496@end deftypefn 4497 4498@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func}) 4499This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for 4500a new target instead. 4501@end defmac 4502 4503@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode}) 4504A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library 4505function returns a value of mode @var{mode}. 4506 4507Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler 4508support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known 4509specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being 4510compiled. 4511@end defmac 4512 4513@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun}) 4514Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall 4515function in order to determine where the result should be returned. 4516 4517The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called 4518library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX 4519representing the place where the library function result will be returned. 4520 4521If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used. 4522@end deftypefn 4523 4524@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno}) 4525A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard 4526register in which the values of called function may come back. 4527 4528A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the 4529second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be 4530recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition 4531suffices: 4532 4533@smallexample 4534#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0) 4535@end smallexample 4536 4537If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called 4538function use different registers for the return value, this macro 4539should recognize only the caller's register numbers. 4540 4541This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} 4542for a new target instead. 4543@end defmac 4544 4545@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno}) 4546A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard 4547register in which the values of called function may come back. 4548 4549A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the 4550second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be 4551recognized by this target hook. 4552 4553If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called 4554function use different registers for the return value, this target hook 4555should recognize only the caller's register numbers. 4556 4557If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used. 4558@end deftypefn 4559 4560@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE 4561Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return} 4562need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for 4563saving and restoring an arbitrary return value. 4564@end defmac 4565 4566@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG 4567Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address 4568is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also 4569arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal 4570pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is 4571undesirable on your target. 4572@end deftypevr 4573 4574@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type}) 4575This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned 4576at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are 4577padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type} 4578is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this. 4579 4580Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must 4581be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2- 4582or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a 45834-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an 4584@code{SImode} rtx. 4585@end deftypefn 4586 4587@node Aggregate Return 4588@subsection How Large Values Are Returned 4589@cindex aggregates as return values 4590@cindex large return values 4591@cindex returning aggregate values 4592@cindex structure value address 4593 4594When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other 4595cases), the value is not returned according to 4596@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the 4597caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value 4598should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value 4599address}. 4600 4601This section describes how to control returning structure values in 4602memory. 4603 4604@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype}) 4605This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the 4606function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned. 4607Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype} 4608will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for 4609libcalls. 4610 4611Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled 4612by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return} 4613takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is 4614possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default 4615definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode} 4616values, and 0 otherwise. 4617 4618Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always 4619be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN} 4620to indicate this. 4621@end deftypefn 4622 4623@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN 4624Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be 4625in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined 4626only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@. 4627If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure 4628and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY} 4629target hook. 4630 4631If not defined, this defaults to the value 1. 4632@end defmac 4633 4634@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming}) 4635This target hook should return the location of the structure value 4636address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is 4637passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may 4638be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target 4639hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first 4640argument. 4641 4642On some architectures the place where the structure value address 4643is found by the called function is not the same place that the 4644caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could 4645be because the function prologue moves it to a different place. 4646@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in 4647the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of 4648the caller. 4649 4650If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the 4651stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If 4652@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the 4653structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need 4654to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point. 4655@end deftypefn 4656 4657@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN 4658Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine 4659for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return 4660the address of a static variable containing the value. 4661 4662Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to 4663pass an address to the subroutine. 4664 4665This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does 4666nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode. 4667@end defmac 4668 4669@deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno}) 4670This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct. 4671@end deftypefn 4672 4673@deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno}) 4674This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct. 4675@end deftypefn 4676 4677@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMPTY_RECORD_P (const_tree @var{type}) 4678This target hook returns true if the type is an empty record. The default 4679is to return @code{false}. 4680@end deftypefn 4681 4682@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_WARN_PARAMETER_PASSING_ABI (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, tree @var{type}) 4683This target hook warns about the change in empty class parameter passing 4684ABI. 4685@end deftypefn 4686 4687@node Caller Saves 4688@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation 4689 4690If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This 4691makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that 4692must live across calls. 4693 4694@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs}) 4695A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs} 4696of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If 4697@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be 4698returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC 4699will select the smallest suitable mode. 4700@end defmac 4701 4702@node Function Entry 4703@subsection Function Entry and Exit 4704@cindex function entry and exit 4705@cindex prologue 4706@cindex epilogue 4707 4708This section describes the macros that output function entry 4709(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code. 4710 4711@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_PRINT_PATCHABLE_FUNCTION_ENTRY (FILE *@var{file}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{patch_area_size}, bool @var{record_p}) 4712Generate a patchable area at the function start, consisting of 4713@var{patch_area_size} NOP instructions. If the target supports named 4714sections and if @var{record_p} is true, insert a pointer to the current 4715location in the table of patchable functions. The default implementation 4716of the hook places the table of pointers in the special section named 4717@code{__patchable_function_entries}. 4718@end deftypefn 4719 4720@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}) 4721If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a 4722function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame, 4723initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be 4724saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the 4725local variables. @var{file} is a stdio stream to which the assembler 4726code should be output. 4727 4728The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this 4729macro. That has already been done when the macro is run. 4730 4731@findex regs_ever_live 4732To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array 4733@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register 4734@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function 4735prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the 4736call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use 4737@code{regs_ever_live}.) 4738 4739On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does 4740not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if 4741they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes 4742appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used 4743registers are used in the function. 4744 4745@findex frame_pointer_needed 4746On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the 4747function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame 4748pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a 4749frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable 4750@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run 4751time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}. 4752 4753The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space 4754required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions 4755listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the 4756order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the 4757stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and 4758the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order 4759for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for 4760compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard 4761or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC 4762need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine. 4763@end deftypefn 4764 4765@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}) 4766If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a 4767prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being 4768emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be 4769emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}. 4770@end deftypefn 4771 4772@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}) 4773If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an 4774epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being 4775emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be 4776emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}. 4777@end deftypefn 4778 4779@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}) 4780If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a 4781function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved 4782registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was 4783called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the 4784same argument as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the 4785registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and 4786@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way. 4787 4788On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work 4789of returning from the function. On these machines, give that 4790instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro 4791@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all. 4792 4793Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the 4794@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target 4795switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used, 4796define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the 4797target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity 4798condition is false, epilogues will be used. 4799 4800On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the 4801function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these 4802two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer 4803is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable 4804@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling 4805a function that needs a frame pointer. 4806 4807Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and 4808@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially. 4809The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a 4810function. @xref{Leaf Functions}. 4811 4812On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while 4813others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when 4814given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed 4815number of arguments. 4816 4817@findex pops_args 4818@findex crtl->args.pops_args 4819Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which 4820functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} 4821needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current 4822function's arguments that this function should pop is available in 4823@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}. 4824@end deftypefn 4825 4826@itemize @bullet 4827@item 4828@findex pretend_args_size 4829@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size 4830A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of 4831uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the 4832stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region 4833if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack 4834arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed 4835yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This 4836region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in 4837registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the 4838features in @code{<stdarg.h>}. 4839 4840@item 4841An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function. 4842The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as 4843the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is 4844machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used 4845in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require 4846a save area. 4847 4848@item 4849A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation 4850boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines, 4851this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the 4852save area closer to the top of the stack. 4853 4854@item 4855@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames 4856Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of 4857@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing 4858argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}. 4859@end itemize 4860 4861@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK 4862Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return 4863instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack 4864pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to 4865adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The 4866default is 0. 4867 4868Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which 4869frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final 4870stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the 4871compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}. 4872@end defmac 4873 4874@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno}) 4875Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are 4876used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame 4877pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed. 4878@end defmac 4879 4880@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno}) 4881Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are 4882used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live 4883on entry to an exception edge. 4884@end defmac 4885 4886@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function}) 4887A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk 4888function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple 4889inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function, 4890adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to 4891the real function. 4892 4893First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that 4894contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument 4895contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer 4896in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue, 4897e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of 4898all other incoming arguments. 4899 4900Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be 4901made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the 4902adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made: 4903 4904@smallexample 4905p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)] 4906@end smallexample 4907 4908After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a 4909@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does 4910not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will 4911return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}. 4912 4913The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with 4914the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all 4915of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} 4916and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked. 4917 4918The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function} 4919have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on 4920some targets, but probably not. 4921 4922If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++ 4923front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls 4924@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does 4925not support varargs. 4926@end deftypefn 4927 4928@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function}) 4929A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able 4930to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the 4931arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the 4932generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations 4933previously exposed. 4934@end deftypefn 4935 4936@node Profiling 4937@subsection Generating Code for Profiling 4938@cindex profiling, code generation 4939 4940These macros will help you generate code for profiling. 4941 4942@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno}) 4943A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some 4944assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}. 4945 4946@findex mcount 4947The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by 4948your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out, 4949compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C 4950compiler and look at the assembler code that results. 4951 4952Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter 4953variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is 4954@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate 4955the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}. 4956@end defmac 4957 4958@defmac PROFILE_HOOK 4959A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly 4960code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does 4961not support profiling. 4962@end defmac 4963 4964@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS 4965Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the 4966@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable 4967allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern 4968implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the 4969@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}. 4970@end defmac 4971 4972@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE 4973Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before 4974the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after. 4975@end defmac 4976 4977@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void) 4978This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue. 4979@end deftypefn 4980 4981@node Tail Calls 4982@subsection Permitting tail calls 4983@cindex tail calls 4984 4985@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp}) 4986True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified 4987call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function, 4988or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call. 4989 4990It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent 4991tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or 4992during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions, 4993as the @code{sibcall} md pattern cannot fail, or fall over to a 4994``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization 4995may vary greatly between different architectures. 4996@end deftypefn 4997 4998@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs}) 4999Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the 5000function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that 5001cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved 5002registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM, 5003TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES, 5004FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM. 5005@end deftypefn 5006 5007@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{}) 5008This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes. 5009@end deftypefn 5010 5011@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree) 5012True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made. 5013@end deftypefn 5014 5015@node Shrink-wrapping separate components 5016@subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components 5017@cindex shrink-wrapping separate components 5018 5019The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as 5020saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the 5021stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting 5022up the static chain, etc. 5023 5024On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and 5025thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are 5026referred to as components and are handled generically by the target 5027independent parts of GCC. 5028 5029Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be 5030shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly 5031teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution 5032paths where this would unnecessary. 5033 5034What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic 5035code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These 5036@code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components} 5037and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the 5038generic code. 5039 5040@deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void) 5041This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those 5042components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function. 5043Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate 5044shrink-wrapping. 5045Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}. 5046If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well. 5047@end deftypefn 5048 5049@deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block) 5050This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those 5051components where either the prologue component has to be executed before 5052the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both. 5053@end deftypefn 5054 5055@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue}) 5056This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those 5057components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge 5058@var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an 5059epilogue instead. 5060@end deftypefn 5061 5062@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap) 5063Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter. 5064@end deftypefn 5065 5066@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap) 5067Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter. 5068@end deftypefn 5069 5070@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap) 5071Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the 5072@code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those 5073components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it 5074will be deleted after this call. 5075@end deftypefn 5076 5077@node Stack Smashing Protection 5078@subsection Stack smashing protection 5079@cindex stack smashing protection 5080 5081@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void) 5082This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use 5083for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the 5084runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value 5085that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this 5086variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}. 5087 5088The default version of this hook creates a variable called 5089@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. 5090@end deftypefn 5091 5092@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void) 5093This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the 5094stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should 5095involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function. 5096 5097The default version of this hook invokes a function called 5098@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is 5099normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. 5100@end deftypefn 5101 5102@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void) 5103Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true. 5104@end deftypefn 5105 5106@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts}) 5107Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value 5108@end deftypefn 5109 5110@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {vec<const char *>} TARGET_GET_VALID_OPTION_VALUES (int @var{option_code}, const char *@var{prefix}) 5111The hook is used for options that have a non-trivial list of possible option values. OPTION_CODE is option code of opt_code enum type. PREFIX is used for bash completion and allows an implementation to return more specific completion based on the prefix. All string values should be allocated from heap memory and consumers should release them. The result will be pruned to cases with PREFIX if not NULL. 5112@end deftypefn 5113 5114@node Miscellaneous Register Hooks 5115@subsection Miscellaneous register hooks 5116@cindex miscellaneous register hooks 5117 5118@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS 5119Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly 5120clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call. 5121That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the 5122linker (e.g.@: stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those 5123modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly 5124in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE. 5125The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook 5126is to enable the fipa-ra optimization. 5127@end deftypevr 5128 5129@node Varargs 5130@section Implementing the Varargs Macros 5131@cindex varargs implementation 5132 5133GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and 5134@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments 5135on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of 5136varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have 5137conditionals to include it. 5138 5139ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in 5140the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional 5141implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which 5142to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of 5143@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is 5144supposed to write the last named argument of the function here. 5145 5146However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find 5147the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described 5148below. 5149 5150@defmac __builtin_saveregs () 5151Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so 5152that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional 5153versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless 5154you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead. 5155 5156On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the 5157control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On 5158other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language, 5159found in @file{libgcc2.c}. 5160 5161Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the 5162beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to 5163@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is. 5164This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts 5165to use them for its own purposes. 5166@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 5167@c 10feb93 5168@end defmac 5169 5170@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg}) 5171This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack 5172argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it 5173returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack 5174argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for 5175fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to 5176verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument 5177of the current function. 5178@end defmac 5179 5180@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object}) 5181Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are 5182passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg} 5183has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the 5184specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together 5185with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}. 5186 5187@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object}, 5188considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what 5189kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on. 5190 5191The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to 5192interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}. 5193@end defmac 5194 5195These machine description macros help implement varargs: 5196 5197@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void) 5198If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to 5199@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very 5200beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The 5201return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value 5202to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}. 5203@end deftypefn 5204 5205@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time}) 5206This target hook offers an alternative to using 5207@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook 5208@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous 5209register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to 5210have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can 5211use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that 5212pass all their arguments on the stack. 5213 5214The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data 5215structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the 5216named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the 5217last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node. 5218 5219The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the 5220argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second, 5221store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued 5222variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you 5223store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack 5224frame. 5225 5226Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at 5227compile time without knowing their data types, 5228@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that 5229have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly 5230for all data types. 5231 5232If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the 5233arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This 5234happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the 5235end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should 5236not generate any instructions in this case. 5237@end deftypefn 5238 5239@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}) 5240Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function 5241argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument. 5242 5243This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} 5244is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns 5245@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named 5246arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false}, 5247but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true}, 5248then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments 5249except the last are treated as named. 5250 5251You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}. 5252@end deftypefn 5253 5254@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree}) 5255While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once 5256for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by 5257@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just 5258before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the 5259function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is 5260@code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is 5261invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted. 5262This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument 5263registers if a target needs it. 5264For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx} 5265passed instead of an argument register. 5266Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook. 5267@end deftypefn 5268 5269@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void) 5270This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call, 5271just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It 5272signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just 5273emitted call are now no longer in use. 5274Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook. 5275@end deftypefn 5276 5277@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}) 5278If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with 5279@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither 5280@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was 5281defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if 5282@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise. 5283Otherwise, you should not define this hook. 5284@end deftypefn 5285 5286@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no}) 5287This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of 5288@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case 5289bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a 5290memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from 5291memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer 5292constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which 5293should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds. 5294@end deftypefn 5295 5296@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no}) 5297This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of 5298@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case 5299@var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a 5300memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in 5301memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer 5302constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which 5303should be used to store @var{bounds}. 5304@end deftypefn 5305 5306@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}) 5307This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds 5308returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding 5309loaded bounds. 5310@end deftypefn 5311 5312@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}) 5313This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds} 5314returned by function call into @var{slot}. 5315@end deftypefn 5316 5317@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time}) 5318Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored 5319into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to 5320@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}. 5321@end deftypefn 5322 5323@node Trampolines 5324@section Support for Nested Functions 5325@cindex support for nested functions 5326@cindex trampolines for nested functions 5327@cindex descriptors for nested functions 5328@cindex nested functions, support for 5329 5330Taking the address of a nested function requires special compiler 5331handling to ensure that the static chain register is loaded when 5332the function is invoked via an indirect call. 5333 5334GCC has traditionally supported nested functions by creating an 5335executable @dfn{trampoline} at run time when the address of a nested 5336function is taken. This is a small piece of code which normally 5337resides on the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. 5338The trampoline loads the static chain register and then jumps to the 5339real address of the nested function. 5340 5341The use of trampolines requires an executable stack, which is a 5342security risk. To avoid this problem, GCC also supports another 5343strategy: using descriptors for nested functions. Under this model, 5344taking the address of a nested function results in a pointer to a 5345non-executable function descriptor object. Initializing the static chain 5346from the descriptor is handled at indirect call sites. 5347 5348On some targets, including HPPA and IA-64, function descriptors may be 5349mandated by the ABI or be otherwise handled in a target-specific way 5350by the back end in its code generation strategy for indirect calls. 5351GCC also provides its own generic descriptor implementation to support the 5352@option{-fno-trampolines} option. In this case runtime detection of 5353function descriptors at indirect call sites relies on descriptor 5354pointers being tagged with a bit that is never set in bare function 5355addresses. Since GCC's generic function descriptors are 5356not ABI-compliant, this option is typically used only on a 5357per-language basis (notably by Ada) or when it can otherwise be 5358applied to the whole program. 5359 5360Define the following hook if your backend either implements ABI-specified 5361descriptor support, or can use GCC's generic descriptor implementation 5362for nested functions. 5363 5364@deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS 5365If the target can use GCC's generic descriptor mechanism for nested 5366functions, define this hook to a power of 2 representing an unused bit 5367in function pointers which can be used to differentiate descriptors at 5368run time. This value gives the number of bytes by which descriptor 5369pointers are misaligned compared to function pointers. For example, on 5370targets that require functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary, a 5371value of either 1 or 2 is appropriate unless the architecture already 5372reserves the bit for another purpose, such as on ARM. 5373 5374Define this hook to 0 if the target implements ABI support for 5375function descriptors in its standard calling sequence, like for example 5376HPPA or IA-64. 5377 5378Using descriptors for nested functions 5379eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require 5380it to be made executable. 5381@end deftypevr 5382 5383The following macros tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and 5384initialize an executable trampoline. You can also use this interface 5385if your back end needs to create ABI-specified non-executable descriptors; in 5386this case the "trampoline" created is the descriptor containing data only. 5387 5388The instructions in an executable trampoline must do two things: load 5389a constant address into the static chain register, and jump to the real 5390address of the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, 5391this requires two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the 5392two addresses exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. 5393On RISC machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a 5394register in two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate 5395immediate operands. 5396 5397The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable 5398parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the 5399immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is 5400simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the 5401proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it 5402may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them 5403separately. 5404 5405@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f}) 5406This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output, 5407on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains 5408the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a 5409label---the label is taken care of automatically. 5410 5411If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed 5412for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move 5413code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code 5414to generate it on the spot. 5415@end deftypefn 5416 5417@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION 5418Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed 5419(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}. 5420@end defmac 5421 5422@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE 5423A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer. 5424@end defmac 5425 5426@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT 5427Alignment required for trampolines, in bits. 5428 5429If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT} 5430is used for aligning trampolines. 5431@end defmac 5432 5433@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain}) 5434This hook is called to initialize a trampoline. 5435@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl} 5436is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an 5437RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function 5438when it is called. 5439 5440If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the 5441first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp} 5442from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}. 5443Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the 5444trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline 5445to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied. 5446 5447If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or 5448enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after 5449initializing the trampoline proper. 5450@end deftypefn 5451 5452@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr}) 5453This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in 5454the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the 5455memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case 5456the address to be used for a function call should be different from the 5457address at which the template was stored, the different address should 5458be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged. 5459If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls. 5460@end deftypefn 5461 5462Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have 5463separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location 5464fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program 5465jumps to that location, it executes the old contents. 5466 5467Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of 5468the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to 5469make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard 5470subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the 5471latter makes initialization faster. 5472 5473To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define 5474the following macro. 5475 5476@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end}) 5477If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction 5478cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would 5479typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and 5480@var{end} are both pointer expressions. 5481@end defmac 5482 5483To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition, 5484you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire 5485cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the 5486beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in 5487its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide. 5488 5489@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE 5490Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their 5491work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements 5492which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named 5493@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}. 5494 5495If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled 5496C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a 5497special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm} 5498statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label 5499global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your 5500special assembler code. 5501@end defmac 5502 5503@node Library Calls 5504@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines 5505@cindex library subroutine names 5506@cindex @file{libgcc.a} 5507 5508@c prevent bad page break with this line 5509Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines. 5510 5511@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES 5512This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get 5513expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to 5514provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there 5515are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide. 5516@end defmac 5517 5518@findex set_optab_libfunc 5519@findex init_one_libfunc 5520@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void) 5521This hook should declare additional library routines or rename 5522existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and 5523@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}. 5524@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal 5525library routines. 5526 5527The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook. 5528@end deftypefn 5529 5530@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX 5531If false (the default), internal library routines start with two 5532underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_} 5533instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This 5534currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this 5535is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also 5536@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}. 5537@end deftypevr 5538 5539@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison}) 5540This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that 5541implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in 5542mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will 5543return a tristate. 5544 5545GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the 5546comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports 5547don't need to define this macro. 5548@end defmac 5549 5550@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED 5551This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison 5552functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first 5553operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal, 5554and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second. 5555If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return 5556@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines 5557in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro. 5558@end defmac 5559 5560@defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE 5561This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide 5562instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which 5563make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit 5564division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which 5565make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive. 5566@end defmac 5567 5568@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage 5569@findex matherr 5570@defmac TARGET_EDOM 5571The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant 5572expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to 5573deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in 5574@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your 5575system. 5576 5577If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports 5578domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the 5579error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when 5580there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so 5581that @code{matherr} is used normally. 5582@end defmac 5583 5584@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage 5585@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX 5586Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that 5587refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems, 5588@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this 5589macro, a reasonable default is used. 5590@end defmac 5591 5592@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class}) 5593This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions 5594@var{fn_class} is present at the runtime. 5595@end deftypefn 5596 5597@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME 5598Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions 5599by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector 5600and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function. 5601This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have 5602the NeXT runtime installed. 5603 5604If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention 5605will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the 5606selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method. 5607 5608In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate 5609scheme, by means of compiler command line switches. 5610@end defmac 5611 5612@node Addressing Modes 5613@section Addressing Modes 5614@cindex addressing modes 5615 5616@c prevent bad page break with this line 5617This is about addressing modes. 5618 5619@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT 5620@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT 5621@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT 5622@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT 5623A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment, 5624pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively. 5625@end defmac 5626 5627@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP 5628@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP 5629A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or 5630post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than 5631the size of the memory operand. 5632@end defmac 5633 5634@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG 5635@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG 5636A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or 5637post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement. 5638@end defmac 5639 5640@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x}) 5641A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which 5642is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of 5643@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)} 5644is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which 5645constant addresses are supported. 5646@end defmac 5647 5648@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) 5649@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code, 5650accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly 5651known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high} 5652expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to 5653@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions. 5654@end defmac 5655 5656@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS 5657A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid 5658memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to 5659the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever 5660accept. 5661@end defmac 5662 5663@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict}) 5664A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory 5665address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}. 5666 5667Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a 5668non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is 5669desired by the caller. 5670 5671The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so 5672that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is 5673considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some 5674kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register 5675must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look 5676up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard 5677register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference 5678if the array holds @code{-1}. 5679 5680The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to 5681accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of 5682register is required. 5683 5684Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref} 5685and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as 5686constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums 5687specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply 5688recognize any @code{const} as legitimate. 5689 5690Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant 5691sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked 5692@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such 5693naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will 5694be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}. 5695 5696@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation 5697On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on 5698the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the 5699target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information 5700into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a 5701@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the 5702@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler 5703Format}. 5704 5705@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} 5706Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for 5707this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro 5708has this syntax: 5709 5710@example 5711#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label}) 5712@end example 5713 5714@noindent 5715and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid 5716address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}. 5717 5718@findex REG_OK_STRICT 5719Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this 5720macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an 5721@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in 5722that case and the non-strict variant otherwise. 5723 5724Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of 5725files that are recompiled when changes are made. 5726@end deftypefn 5727 5728@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT 5729A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'} 5730character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint 5731letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by 5732@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to 5733support new address formats in your back end without changing the 5734semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to 5735preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the 5736@code{'m'} constraint. 5737@end defmac 5738 5739@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x}) 5740A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}, 5741or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c} 5742can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places: 5743@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}. 5744 5745It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so 5746that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses. 5747 5748The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing 5749a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@. 5750@end defmac 5751 5752@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 5753This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an 5754operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory 5755address. 5756 5757@findex break_out_memory_refs 5758@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs}, 5759and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce 5760@var{x}. 5761 5762The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of 5763@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it 5764should return the new @var{x}. 5765 5766It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address, 5767with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}). 5768The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if 5769the target supports only emulated TLS, it 5770is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find 5771a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent 5772strategy can generate better code. 5773@end deftypefn 5774 5775@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win}) 5776A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address 5777that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode 5778@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code. 5779It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for 5780performance reasons. 5781 5782For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single 5783reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo 5784registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC 5785processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address 5786needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining 5787@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses 5788generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus 5789be shared. 5790 5791@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary 5792to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this, 5793and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge 5794of reload internals. 5795 5796@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a 5797previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses 5798then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort. 5799 5800@findex push_reload 5801The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that 5802need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually 5803suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}. 5804 5805The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of 5806@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it 5807should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value. 5808This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling 5809@code{push_reload}. 5810 5811@findex strict_memory_address_p 5812The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if 5813the address has become legitimate. 5814 5815@findex copy_rtx 5816If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing 5817this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a 5818single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the 5819top level, you'll need to replace first the top level. 5820It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate 5821address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code. 5822@end defmac 5823 5824@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace}) 5825This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address 5826space @var{addrspace} can have 5827different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory 5828reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes 5829but not others. 5830 5831Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent 5832effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size 5833of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent 5834addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses. 5835 5836You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine. 5837 5838The default version of this hook returns @code{false}. 5839@end deftypefn 5840 5841@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}) 5842This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a 5843@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that 5844@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. 5845 5846The default definition returns true. 5847@end deftypefn 5848 5849@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}) 5850This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the 5851@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target 5852macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol 5853references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar 5854addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand 5855the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back 5856into their original form. 5857@end deftypefn 5858 5859@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x}) 5860This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into 5861debug sections. 5862@end deftypefn 5863 5864@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}) 5865This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or 5866should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode 5867of @var{x}. 5868 5869The default version of this hook returns false. 5870 5871The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from 5872deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded 5873from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register 5874holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses 5875of TLS symbols for various targets. 5876@end deftypefn 5877 5878@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x}) 5879This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can 5880be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode 5881of @var{x}. 5882 5883The default version returns false for all constants. 5884@end deftypefn 5885 5886@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl}) 5887This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should 5888be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. 5889 5890The default version returns true for all decls. 5891@end deftypefn 5892 5893@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl}) 5894This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the 5895reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or 5896@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. 5897@end deftypefn 5898 5899@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void) 5900This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an 5901address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be 5902used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in 5903@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned. 5904 5905The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address 5906@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from 5907the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a 5908@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the 5909two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, 5910@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and 5911the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted 5912from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is 5913@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last 5914@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first 5915@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}. 5916 5917If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call 5918to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will 5919use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to 5920@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f} 5921should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD} 5922described above. 5923If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as 5924the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low 5925log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered. 5926@end deftypefn 5927 5928@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign}) 5929Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model. 5930For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and 5931misalignment value (@var{misalign}). 5932@end deftypefn 5933 5934@deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_uint64 TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type}) 5935This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for accesses to 5936vectors of type @var{type} in vectorized code. This might be less than 5937or greater than the ABI-defined value returned by 5938@code{TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT}. It can be equal to the alignment of 5939a single element, in which case the vectorizer will not try to optimize 5940for alignment. 5941 5942The default hook returns @code{TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type})}, which is 5943correct for most targets. 5944@end deftypefn 5945 5946@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed}) 5947Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned. 5948@end deftypefn 5949 5950@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{output}, rtx @var{in0}, rtx @var{in1}, const vec_perm_indices @var{&sel}) 5951This hook is used to test whether the target can permute up to two 5952vectors of mode @var{mode} using the permutation vector @code{sel}, and 5953also to emit such a permutation. In the former case @var{in0}, @var{in1} 5954and @var{out} are all null. In the latter case @var{in0} and @var{in1} are 5955the source vectors and @var{out} is the destination vector; all three are 5956registers of mode @var{mode}. @var{in1} is the same as @var{in0} if 5957@var{sel} describes a permutation on one vector instead of two. 5958 5959Return true if the operation is possible, emitting instructions for it 5960if rtxes are provided. 5961 5962@cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern 5963If the hook returns false for a mode with multibyte elements, GCC will 5964try the equivalent byte operation. If that also fails, it will try forcing 5965the selector into a register and using the @var{vec_perm@var{mode}} 5966instruction pattern. There is no need for the hook to handle these two 5967implementation approaches itself. 5968@end deftypefn 5969 5970@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type}) 5971This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the 5972input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}. 5973The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and 5974specifies how the conversion is to be applied 5975(truncation, rounding, etc.). 5976 5977If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the 5978@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing 5979conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}. 5980@end deftypefn 5981 5982@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in}) 5983This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the 5984vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code 5985@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. 5986The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type 5987@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}. 5988@end deftypefn 5989 5990@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in}) 5991This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the 5992vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The 5993return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type 5994@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}. 5995@end deftypefn 5996 5997@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed}) 5998This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector 5999store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment} 6000parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and 6001the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} 6002parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct. 6003@end deftypefn 6004 6005@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (scalar_mode @var{mode}) 6006This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar 6007mode @var{mode}. The default is 6008equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some 6009transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware. 6010@end deftypefn 6011 6012@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_SPLIT_REDUCTION (machine_mode) 6013This hook should return the preferred mode to split the final reduction 6014step on @var{mode} to. The reduction is then carried out reducing upper 6015against lower halves of vectors recursively until the specified mode is 6016reached. The default is @var{mode} which means no splitting. 6017@end deftypefn 6018 6019@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (vector_sizes *@var{sizes}) 6020If the mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is not 6021the only one that is worth considering, this hook should add all suitable 6022vector sizes to @var{sizes}, in order of decreasing preference. The first 6023one should be the size of @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}. 6024 6025The hook does not need to do anything if the vector returned by 6026@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is the only one relevant 6027for autovectorization. The default implementation does nothing. 6028@end deftypefn 6029 6030@deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (poly_uint64 @var{nunits}, poly_uint64 @var{length}) 6031A vector mask is a value that holds one boolean result for every element 6032in a vector. This hook returns the machine mode that should be used to 6033represent such a mask when the vector in question is @var{length} bytes 6034long and contains @var{nunits} elements. The hook returns an empty 6035@code{opt_machine_mode} if no such mode exists. 6036 6037The default implementation returns the mode of an integer vector that 6038is @var{length} bytes long and that contains @var{nunits} elements, 6039if such a mode exists. 6040@end deftypefn 6041 6042@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_EMPTY_MASK_IS_EXPENSIVE (unsigned @var{ifn}) 6043This hook returns true if masked internal function @var{ifn} (really of 6044type @code{internal_fn}) should be considered expensive when the mask is 6045all zeros. GCC can then try to branch around the instruction instead. 6046@end deftypefn 6047 6048@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info}) 6049This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized. 6050@end deftypefn 6051 6052@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where}) 6053This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised. 6054@end deftypefn 6055 6056@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost}) 6057This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators. 6058@end deftypefn 6059 6060@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data}) 6061This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator. 6062@end deftypefn 6063 6064@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale}) 6065Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype} 6066is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of 6067the index, scaled by @var{scale}. 6068The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather 6069loads. 6070@end deftypefn 6071 6072@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale}) 6073Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype} 6074is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of 6075the index, scaled by @var{scale}. 6076The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter 6077stores. 6078@end deftypefn 6079 6080@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int}) 6081This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float} 6082fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also 6083@var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0. 6084The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted, 6085or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted. 6086@end deftypefn 6087 6088@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{}) 6089This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute 6090to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed. 6091@end deftypefn 6092 6093@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{}) 6094This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used 6095in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is 6096usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is 6097to use it. 6098@end deftypefn 6099 6100@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void) 6101Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target. 6102@end deftypefn 6103 6104@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level}, unsigned @var{used}) 6105This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC 6106compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1 6107and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the 6108function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the 6109outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook 6110should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults 6111are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in. 6112Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return 6113true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to 6114provide dimensions larger than 1. 6115@end deftypefn 6116 6117@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis}) 6118This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension, 6119or zero if unbounded. 6120@end deftypefn 6121 6122@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork}) 6123This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN 6124function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they 6125should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass. 6126It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should 6127return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific 6128gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it). 6129The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them. 6130@end deftypefn 6131 6132@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call}) 6133This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the 6134@var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple 6135instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to 6136the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the 6137expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible 6138for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary. 6139@end deftypefn 6140 6141@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PREFERRED_ELSE_VALUE (unsigned @var{ifn}, tree @var{type}, unsigned @var{nops}, tree *@var{ops}) 6142This hook returns the target's preferred final argument for a call 6143to conditional internal function @var{ifn} (really of type 6144@code{internal_fn}). @var{type} specifies the return type of the 6145function and @var{ops} are the operands to the conditional operation, 6146of which there are @var{nops}. 6147 6148For example, if @var{ifn} is @code{IFN_COND_ADD}, the hook returns 6149a value of type @var{type} that should be used when @samp{@var{ops}[0]} 6150and @samp{@var{ops}[1]} are conditionally added together. 6151 6152This hook is only relevant if the target supports conditional patterns 6153like @code{cond_add@var{m}}. The default implementation returns a zero 6154constant of type @var{type}. 6155@end deftypefn 6156 6157@node Anchored Addresses 6158@section Anchored Addresses 6159@cindex anchored addresses 6160@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors} 6161 6162GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity. 6163For example, if we have: 6164 6165@smallexample 6166static int a, b, c; 6167int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @} 6168@end smallexample 6169 6170the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic 6171addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets, 6172it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access 6173the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would 6174be something like: 6175 6176@smallexample 6177int foo (void) 6178@{ 6179 register int *xr = &x; 6180 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x]; 6181@} 6182@end smallexample 6183 6184(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as 6185``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}. 6186 6187The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know 6188in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use 6189section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET} 6190or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value. 6191 6192@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET 6193The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor. 6194On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be 6195applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address 6196for every mode. The default value is 0. 6197@end deftypevr 6198 6199@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET 6200Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive) 6201offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default 6202value is 0. 6203@end deftypevr 6204 6205@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x}) 6206Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a 6207@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true. 6208The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning 6209of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}. 6210 6211If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses 6212it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}. 6213If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition 6214is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether. 6215@end deftypefn 6216 6217@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x}) 6218Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF} 6219@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and 6220@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}. 6221 6222The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to 6223intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes 6224or target-specific sections. 6225@end deftypefn 6226 6227@node Condition Code 6228@section Condition Code Status 6229@cindex condition code status 6230 6231The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the 6232two ways of representing condition codes in GCC. 6233 6234The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation 6235(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit 6236clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code 6237register representation, which provides better schedulability for 6238architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which 6239most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes 6240most RISC machines. 6241 6242The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of 6243the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition 6244and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping 6245arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks. 6246Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally, 6247the definition may be the source of exception handling edges. 6248 6249These restrictions can prevent important 6250optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there 6251is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set 6252three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction 6253scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to 6254separate the definition and use of the condition code register. 6255 6256For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to 6257represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific 6258condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the 6259condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register, 6260or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register. 6261Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode 6262that is in class @code{MODE_CC}. 6263 6264Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is 6265specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not 6266interested in most macros in this section. 6267 6268@menu 6269* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes. 6270* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes. 6271@end menu 6272 6273@node CC0 Condition Codes 6274@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)} 6275@findex cc0 6276 6277@findex cc_status 6278The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to 6279describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of 6280the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This 6281variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is 6282currently based, and several standard flags. 6283 6284Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine 6285description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific 6286information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}. 6287 6288@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP 6289C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep} 6290component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}. 6291 6292This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}. 6293@end defmac 6294 6295@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT 6296A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''. 6297The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use 6298the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably 6299define this macro to initialize it. 6300 6301This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}. 6302@end defmac 6303 6304@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn}) 6305A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status} 6306appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is 6307this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition 6308code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly 6309set @code{(cc0)}. 6310 6311This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}. 6312 6313If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter 6314other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they 6315invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as 6316reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address 6317registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually 6318@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such 6319insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code 6320based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new 6321value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by 6322this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of 6323@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter 6324@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the 6325condition code value. 6326 6327The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal 6328with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are 6329@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or 6330constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these 6331insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What 6332@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run 6333@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}. 6334 6335A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function 6336that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example, 6337@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in 6338two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}. 6339@end defmac 6340 6341@node MODE_CC Condition Codes 6342@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers 6343@findex CCmode 6344@findex MODE_CC 6345 6346@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y}) 6347On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions 6348than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition 6349code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines 6350when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow 6351bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different 6352branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When 6353this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to 6354record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can 6355also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g.@: a signed or an 6356unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes. 6357 6358If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to 6359@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose 6360a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes 6361have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example, 6362by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should 6363be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support 6364the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern 6365 6366@smallexample 6367(define_insn "" 6368 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0) 6369 (compare:CCNZ 6370 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r") 6371 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI")) 6372 (const_int 0)))] 6373 "" 6374 "@dots{}") 6375@end smallexample 6376 6377@noindent 6378together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode} 6379for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}: 6380 6381@smallexample 6382#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \ 6383 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \ 6384 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \ 6385 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \ 6386 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \ 6387 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \ 6388 ? CCNZmode : CCmode)) 6389@end smallexample 6390 6391Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands 6392were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in 6393this section. 6394 6395You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes 6396in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}. 6397@end defmac 6398 6399@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value}) 6400On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can 6401convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha 6402does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT} 6403comparison instead and swap the order of the operands. 6404 6405On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions. 6406@var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1} 6407are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If 6408@var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not 6409allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used 6410in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not 6411allowed to swap operands in that case. 6412 6413GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is 6414valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the 6415@file{md} file. 6416 6417You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the 6418comparison code or operands. 6419@end deftypefn 6420 6421@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode}) 6422A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a 6423comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} 6424can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison, 6425then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero. 6426 6427You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the 6428floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}. 6429For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point 6430inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}: 6431 6432@smallexample 6433#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \ 6434 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode) 6435@end smallexample 6436@end defmac 6437 6438@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode}) 6439A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for 6440comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case 6441@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case 6442machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For 6443instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may 6444freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look 6445like: 6446 6447@smallexample 6448#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \ 6449 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \ 6450 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE)) 6451@end smallexample 6452@end defmac 6453 6454@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2}) 6455On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard 6456register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the 6457regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the 6458hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a 6459small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true 6460to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its 6461arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes. 6462When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the 6463integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to 6464@code{INVALID_REGNUM}. 6465 6466The default version of this hook returns false. 6467@end deftypefn 6468 6469@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2}) 6470On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class 6471@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be 6472validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this 6473target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which 6474both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode, 6475return @code{VOIDmode}. 6476 6477The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the 6478same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it 6479returns @code{VOIDmode}. 6480@end deftypefn 6481 6482@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM 6483If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately. 6484@end deftypevr 6485 6486@node Costs 6487@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations 6488@cindex costs of instructions 6489@cindex relative costs 6490@cindex speed of instructions 6491 6492These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations 6493on the target machine. 6494 6495@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to}) 6496A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a 6497register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are 6498expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A 6499value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to 6500that. 6501 6502It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the 6503same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between 6504registers if they are not general registers. 6505 6506If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two 6507hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their 6508classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the 6509constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will 6510allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this 6511if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying. 6512 6513These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook 6514@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead. 6515@end defmac 6516 6517@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to}) 6518This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} 6519from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes 6520are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. 6521A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to 6522that. 6523 6524It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the 6525same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between 6526registers if they are not general registers. 6527 6528If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two 6529hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their 6530classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the 6531constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will 6532allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this 6533if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying. 6534 6535The default version of this function returns 2. 6536@end deftypefn 6537 6538@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in}) 6539A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a 6540register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value 6541is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost 6542is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between 6543registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you 6544should define this macro to express the relative cost. 6545 6546If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus 6547the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is 6548needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy 6549between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is 6550more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to 6551reflect the actual cost of the move. 6552 6553GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if 6554secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via 6555a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a 6556secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of 65574 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other 6558value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function 6559are the same as to this macro. 6560 6561These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook 6562@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead. 6563@end defmac 6564 6565@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in}) 6566This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} 6567between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false} 6568if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in. 6569This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. 6570If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two 6571registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost. 6572 6573If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus 6574the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is 6575needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy 6576between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is 6577more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to 6578reflect the actual cost of the move. 6579 6580GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if 6581secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via 6582a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a 6583secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of 65844 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other 6585value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function 6586are the same as to this target hook. 6587@end deftypefn 6588 6589@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p}) 6590A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is 6591the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter 6592@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized 6593for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value 6594optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is 6595true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the 6596@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then. 6597@end defmac 6598 6599Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs, 6600but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would 6601ordinarily expect. 6602 6603@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS 6604Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less 6605than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no 6606faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access 6607require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost 6608between byte and (aligned) word loads. 6609 6610When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by 6611finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword 6612load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are 6613faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it 6614may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to 6615other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes. 6616@end defmac 6617 6618@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned int @var{align}) 6619This hook returns true if memory accesses described by the 6620@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater 6621than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap handler. 6622This hook is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e.@: when 6623@code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}. 6624 6625When this hook returns true, the compiler will act as if 6626@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were true when generating code for block 6627moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced. 6628Therefore, do not make this hook return true if unaligned accesses only 6629add a cycle or two to the time for a memory access. 6630 6631The hook must return true whenever @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is true. 6632The default implementation returns @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT}. 6633@end deftypefn 6634 6635@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed}) 6636The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below} 6637which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a 6638string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always 6639make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size. 6640 6641Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a 6642@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts 6643the number of such sequences. 6644 6645The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being 6646optimized for speed rather than size. 6647 6648If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used. 6649@end defmac 6650 6651@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p}) 6652GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between 6653two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example 6654when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure 6655implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move 6656insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the 6657@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit 6658unit-by-unit, loop-based operations. 6659 6660This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a 6661given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces} 6662infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation. 6663Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage 6664units. 6665 6666The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES}, 6667@code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or 6668@code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation 6669under consideration. 6670 6671The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being 6672optimized for speed rather than size. 6673 6674Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation 6675for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the 6676@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or 6677@code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of 6678insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of 6679the body of the memory operation. 6680 6681Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase 6682in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a 6683move would be greater than that of a library call. 6684@end deftypefn 6685 6686@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode}) 6687When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the 6688number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook 6689allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the 6690factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with 6691one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a 6692particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a 6693negative number from this hook. 6694@end deftypefn 6695 6696@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES 6697A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit 6698a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}. 6699@end defmac 6700 6701@defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES 6702A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit 6703a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times 6704the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller. 6705@end defmac 6706 6707@defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES 6708A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit 6709a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to 6710@code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}. 6711@end defmac 6712 6713@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed}) 6714The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence 6715of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn 6716or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but 6717eventually incurs high cost in increased code size. 6718 6719The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being 6720optimized for speed rather than size. 6721 6722If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used. 6723@end defmac 6724 6725@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed}) 6726The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence 6727of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of 6728a block set insn or a library call. 6729Increasing the value will always make code faster, but 6730eventually incurs high cost in increased code size. 6731 6732The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being 6733optimized for speed rather than size. 6734 6735If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}. 6736@end defmac 6737 6738@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode}) 6739A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good 6740thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6741@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}. 6742@end defmac 6743 6744@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode}) 6745A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good 6746thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6747@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}. 6748@end defmac 6749 6750@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode}) 6751A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good 6752thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6753@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}. 6754@end defmac 6755 6756@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode}) 6757A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good 6758thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6759@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}. 6760@end defmac 6761 6762@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode}) 6763A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good 6764thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6765@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}. 6766@end defmac 6767 6768@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode}) 6769A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good 6770thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6771@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}. 6772@end defmac 6773 6774@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode}) 6775This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good 6776thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6777@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}. 6778@end defmac 6779 6780@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode}) 6781This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good 6782thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of 6783@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}. 6784@end defmac 6785 6786@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE 6787Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant 6788function address than to call an address kept in a register. 6789@end defmac 6790 6791@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT 6792Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by 6793@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if 6794@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2. 6795@end defmac 6796 6797@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type}) 6798Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with 6799modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}. 6800The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction 6801whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion 6802optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}. 6803 6804For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and 6805@var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the 6806optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}. 6807 6808The default hook returns true for all inputs. 6809@end deftypefn 6810 6811@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed}) 6812This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions. 6813 6814The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is 6815available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears 6816as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}. 6817That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such 6818that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that 6819either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or 6820(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}. 6821 6822@var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that 6823do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used. 6824 6825In implementing this hook, you can use the construct 6826@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast 6827instructions. 6828 6829On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate 6830for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as 6831necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)} 6832for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus 6833operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations. 6834 6835When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is 6836false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative 6837size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}. 6838 6839The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been 6840processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse. 6841@end deftypefn 6842 6843@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed}) 6844This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains 6845@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from 6846the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook. 6847 6848For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the 6849true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all 6850instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence 6851all addresses will have equal costs. 6852 6853In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with 6854the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest, 6855cost, the one that is the most complex will be used. 6856 6857For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register 6858and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro 6859is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory 6860references will be indirect through that register. On machines where 6861the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than 6862that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional 6863instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper 6864specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines. 6865 6866This hook is never called with an invalid address. 6867 6868On machines where an address involving more than one register is as 6869cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining 6870@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to 6871be live over a region of code where only one would have been if 6872@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect 6873should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs 6874should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of 6875registers on machines with lots of registers. 6876@end deftypefn 6877 6878@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_INSN_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, bool @var{speed}) 6879This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL instructions. 6880 6881In implementing this hook, you can use the construct 6882@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast 6883instructions. 6884 6885When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is 6886false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative 6887size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}. 6888@end deftypefn 6889 6890@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e}) 6891This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS}, 6892giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL 6893if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available. 6894The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations 6895that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and 6896@code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the 6897unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. 6898RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence 6899is greater than the value returned by this hook. 6900 6901@code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional 6902branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition 6903were true. 6904 6905The default implementation of this hook uses the 6906@code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set, 6907and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise. 6908@end deftypefn 6909 6910@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NOCE_CONVERSION_PROFITABLE_P (rtx_insn *@var{seq}, struct noce_if_info *@var{if_info}) 6911This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good 6912candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in 6913@code{if_info}. 6914@end deftypefn 6915 6916@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void) 6917This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow 6918speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets 6919such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without 6920delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance, 6921disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of 6922delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable 6923as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble. 6924@end deftypefn 6925 6926@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ESTIMATED_POLY_VALUE (poly_int64 @var{val}) 6927Return an estimate of the runtime value of @var{val}, for use in 6928things like cost calculations or profiling frequencies. The default 6929implementation returns the lowest possible value of @var{val}. 6930@end deftypefn 6931 6932@node Scheduling 6933@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler 6934 6935The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific 6936adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target 6937hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of 6938them: try the first ones in this list first. 6939 6940@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void) 6941This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever 6942issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one. 6943Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue 6944an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional 6945constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see 6946hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}). 6947This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need 6948it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use 6949@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}. 6950@end deftypefn 6951 6952@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more}) 6953This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn 6954from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can 6955still be issued in the current cycle. The default is 6956@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and 6957@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate. 6958You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources 6959than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle. 6960@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any 6961debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by 6962@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that 6963was scheduled. 6964@end deftypefn 6965 6966@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw}) 6967This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the 6968relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a 6969dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new 6970value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be 6971used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline 6972description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost 6973as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline 6974description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of 6975output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency 6976times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not 6977acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also 6978@pxref{Processor pipeline description}. 6979@end deftypefn 6980 6981@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority}) 6982This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of 6983@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to 6984execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn} 6985later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the 6986scheduling priorities of insns. 6987@end deftypefn 6988 6989@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock}) 6990This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready 6991list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to 6992combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines). 6993@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any 6994debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by 6995@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready 6996list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is 6997a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler 6998reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with 6999@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock} 7000is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and 7001the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that 7002can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also 7003@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}. 7004@end deftypefn 7005 7006@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock}) 7007Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That 7008function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one 7009is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after 7010@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and 7011return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining 7012this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where 7013scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same 7014cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly. 7015@end deftypefn 7016 7017@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void) 7018This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion. 7019@end deftypefn 7020 7021@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr}) 7022This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for 7023a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair 7024(@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched 7025group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either 7026two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should 7027validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together. 7028@end deftypefn 7029 7030@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail}) 7031This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in 7032chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail} 7033correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For 7034example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires 7035analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward 7036dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already 7037calculated. 7038@end deftypefn 7039 7040@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready}) 7041This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of 7042instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null 7043pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose} 7044is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. 7045@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling 7046region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate 7047scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}. 7048@end deftypefn 7049 7050@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}) 7051This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of 7052instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform 7053cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file} 7054is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output 7055to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by 7056@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. 7057@end deftypefn 7058 7059@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid}) 7060This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations. 7061@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. 7062@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. 7063@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins. 7064@end deftypefn 7065 7066@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}) 7067This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}. 7068@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. 7069@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. 7070@end deftypefn 7071 7072@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void) 7073The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the 7074pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled 7075when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may 7076simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW} 7077processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton 7078based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state 7079when the new simulated processor cycle starts. 7080@end deftypefn 7081 7082@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void) 7083The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook. 7084@end deftypefn 7085 7086@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void) 7087The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used 7088to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new 7089simulated processor cycle finishes. 7090@end deftypefn 7091 7092@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void) 7093The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but 7094used to initialize data used by the previous hook. 7095@end deftypefn 7096 7097@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void) 7098The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish. 7099The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used 7100to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing 7101state on a single insn is not enough. 7102@end deftypefn 7103 7104@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void) 7105The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started. 7106The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used 7107to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing 7108state on a single insn is not enough. 7109@end deftypefn 7110 7111@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void) 7112This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue 7113for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler 7114chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive 7115value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of 7116@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()} 7117subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in 7118maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the 7119@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of 7120packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the 7121rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton. 7122 7123This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC} 7124processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor 7125with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or 7126@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or 7127@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The 7128processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into 7129@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B} 7130until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first, 7131the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle. 7132 7133Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based 7134pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn 7135schedules to choose the best one. 7136 7137The default is no multipass scheduling. 7138@end deftypefn 7139 7140@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index}) 7141 7142This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be 7143considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns 7144zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling. 7145Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on 7146the current round of multipass scheduling. 7147Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given 7148number of cycles. 7149Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority 7150instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed 7151to allow backends make correct judgements. 7152 7153The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued. 7154@end deftypefn 7155 7156@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p}) 7157This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass 7158scheduling. 7159@end deftypefn 7160 7161@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data}) 7162This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN. 7163@end deftypefn 7164 7165@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}) 7166This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of 7167an instruction. 7168@end deftypefn 7169 7170@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data}) 7171This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current 7172round of multipass scheduling. 7173@end deftypefn 7174 7175@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data}) 7176This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling. 7177@end deftypefn 7178 7179@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data}) 7180This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling. 7181@end deftypefn 7182 7183@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p}) 7184This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn} 7185on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero, 7186@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead, 7187the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p} 7188is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle 7189start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and 7190verbosity level to use for debugging output. 7191@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the 7192processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued, 7193and the current processor cycle. 7194@end deftypefn 7195 7196@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance}) 7197This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by 7198the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that 7199are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters 7200to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence 7201being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the 7202dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third 7203parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns. 7204The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two 7205insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target, 7206and @code{false} otherwise. 7207 7208Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines, 7209where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource 7210delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping 7211that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very 7212important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns 7213closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however, 7214not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define. 7215@end deftypefn 7216 7217@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void) 7218This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to 7219the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its 7220per instruction data structures. 7221@end deftypefn 7222 7223@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void) 7224Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context. 7225@end deftypefn 7226 7227@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p}) 7228Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context. 7229It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the 7230beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}. 7231@end deftypefn 7232 7233@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}) 7234Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context. 7235@end deftypefn 7236 7237@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}) 7238Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}. 7239@end deftypefn 7240 7241@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}) 7242Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}. 7243@end deftypefn 7244 7245@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat}) 7246This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only 7247speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively. 7248The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative 7249version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative 7250pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form, 7251or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested 7252speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned 7253the generated speculative pattern. 7254@end deftypefn 7255 7256@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status}) 7257This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code 7258for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check 7259instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise. 7260@end deftypefn 7261 7262@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds}) 7263This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery 7264check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a 7265speculative instruction for which the check should be generated. 7266@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should 7267be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to 7268recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then 7269a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by 7270@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null. 7271@end deftypefn 7272 7273@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info}) 7274This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be 7275enabled/used. 7276The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target. 7277The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler. 7278@end deftypefn 7279 7280@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_CAN_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}) 7281Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually 7282 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong. Often such 7283 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the 7284 pipeline descriptions. This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn} 7285 should not be speculated. 7286@end deftypefn 7287 7288@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g}) 7289This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a 7290resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in 7291the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target 7292backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower 7293bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number 7294of instructions divided by the issue rate. 7295@end deftypefn 7296 7297@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x}) 7298This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling 7299is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true. 7300@end deftypefn 7301 7302@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x}) 7303This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified 7304in its second parameter. 7305@end deftypefn 7306 7307@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE 7308True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just 7309the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but 7310also the latencies of operations. 7311@end deftypevr 7312 7313@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 7314This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of 7315parallelism required in output calculations chain. 7316@end deftypefn 7317 7318@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri}) 7319This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion 7320priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities 7321are returned via pointer parameters. 7322 7323@var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated. 7324@var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases. 7325@var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s 7326fusion priority should be calculated and returned. 7327@var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority 7328should be calculated and returned. 7329 7330Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should 7331be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for 7332instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major 7333sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be 7334scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated 7335should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid 7336false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be 7337scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant 7338instructions. 7339 7340Given below example: 7341 7342@smallexample 7343 ldr r10, [r1, 4] 7344 add r4, r4, r10 7345 ldr r15, [r2, 8] 7346 sub r5, r5, r15 7347 ldr r11, [r1, 0] 7348 add r4, r4, r11 7349 ldr r16, [r2, 12] 7350 sub r5, r5, r16 7351@end smallexample 7352 7353On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be 7354merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive 7355loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where 7356this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each 7357instruction based on its fustion type, like: 7358 7359@smallexample 7360 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96 7361 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100 7362 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92 7363 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100 7364 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100 7365 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100 7366 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88 7367 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100 7368@end smallexample 7369 7370Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according 7371to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be 7372pushed together in instruction flow, like: 7373 7374@smallexample 7375 ldr r11, [r1, 0] 7376 ldr r10, [r1, 4] 7377 ldr r15, [r2, 8] 7378 ldr r16, [r2, 12] 7379 add r4, r4, r10 7380 sub r5, r5, r15 7381 add r4, r4, r11 7382 sub r5, r5, r16 7383@end smallexample 7384 7385Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads. 7386 7387Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion 7388work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect. 7389 7390This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to 7391the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported. 7392@end deftypefn 7393 7394@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem}) 7395Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have 7396hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs. 7397@end deftypefn 7398 7399@node Sections 7400@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{}) 7401@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between 7402@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93 7403 7404An object file is divided into sections containing different types of 7405data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text 7406section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data 7407section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss 7408section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds 7409of sections. 7410 7411@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as 7412@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}. 7413The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable 7414is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro, 7415as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c} 7416initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants. 7417They may however depend on command-line flags. 7418 7419@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make 7420use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them 7421to be string literals. 7422 7423Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a 7424section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you 7425should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use 7426@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections. 7427 7428You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining 7429@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section} 7430in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of 7431@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not 7432create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to 7433reuse @code{text_section}. 7434 7435All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null 7436if the target does not provide them. 7437 7438@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP 7439A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the 7440assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data. 7441Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right. 7442@end defmac 7443 7444@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME 7445If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most 7446frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide 7447a default definition if the target supports named sections. 7448@end defmac 7449 7450@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME 7451If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely 7452executed functions in the program. 7453@end defmac 7454 7455@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP 7456A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the 7457assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized 7458data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right. 7459@end defmac 7460 7461@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP 7462If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, 7463containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as 7464initialized, writable small data. 7465@end defmac 7466 7467@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP 7468A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the 7469assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized 7470data. 7471@end defmac 7472 7473@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP 7474If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, 7475containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as 7476uninitialized global data. If not defined, and 7477@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined, 7478uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if 7479@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be 7480used. 7481@end defmac 7482 7483@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP 7484If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, 7485containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as 7486uninitialized, writable small data. 7487@end defmac 7488 7489@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP 7490If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the 7491assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local 7492common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}. 7493@end defmac 7494 7495@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG 7496If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant 7497containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The 7498default is @code{'T'}. 7499@end defmac 7500 7501@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP 7502If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, 7503containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as 7504initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does 7505not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section} 7506variable; it is used entirely in runtime code. 7507@end defmac 7508 7509@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP 7510If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, 7511containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as 7512finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does 7513not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section} 7514variable; it is used entirely in runtime code. 7515@end defmac 7516 7517@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP 7518If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, 7519containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as 7520part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not 7521defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define 7522both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. 7523@end defmac 7524 7525@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP 7526If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, 7527containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as 7528part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not 7529defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define 7530both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}. 7531@end defmac 7532 7533@defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG 7534If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant 7535containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This 7536corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag. 7537@end defmac 7538 7539@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function}) 7540If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section 7541via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to 7542the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if 7543@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls 7544to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini 7545sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some 7546ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on 7547registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that 7548constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section. 7549@end defmac 7550 7551@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION 7552If defined, a string which names the section into which small 7553variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful 7554when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and 7555you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what 7556they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application 7557expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like 7558MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't 7559require small data support from your application, but use this macro 7560to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can 7561access these variables whether it uses small data or not. 7562@end defmac 7563 7564@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN 7565If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some 7566arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the 7567@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment 7568and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding. 7569@end defmac 7570 7571@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION 7572Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump 7573tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text 7574section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the 7575readonly data section is used. 7576 7577This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section. 7578@end defmac 7579 7580@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void) 7581Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the 7582@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections 7583of its own that you need to create. 7584 7585GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing 7586any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks 7587described below. 7588@end deftypefn 7589 7590@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void) 7591Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when 7592selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations 7593should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if 7594local relocations should be placed in a read-write section. 7595 7596The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic} 7597is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined 7598when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations 7599in read-only sections even in executables. 7600@end deftypefn 7601 7602@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_GENERATE_PIC_ADDR_DIFF_VEC (void) 7603Return true to generate ADDR_DIF_VEC table 7604or false to generate ADDR_VEC table for jumps in case of -fPIC. 7605 7606The default version of this function returns true if flag_pic 7607equals true and false otherwise 7608@end deftypefn 7609 7610@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align}) 7611Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can 7612assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of 7613some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} 7614requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains 7615local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations. 7616@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits. 7617 7618The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only 7619variables in @code{readonly_data_section}. 7620 7621See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}. 7622@end deftypefn 7623 7624@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS 7625Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called 7626for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants. 7627 7628In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the 7629function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if 7630it is unlikely to be called. 7631@end defmac 7632 7633@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc}) 7634Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node, 7635and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}. 7636As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether 7637the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations. 7638 7639The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the 7640ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For 7641example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}. 7642Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough. 7643@end deftypefn 7644 7645@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl}) 7646Return the readonly data section associated with 7647@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}. 7648The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if 7649the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name} 7650if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section 7651otherwise. 7652@end deftypefn 7653 7654@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX 7655Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct 7656section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override 7657the string if a different section name should be used. 7658@end deftypevr 7659 7660@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void) 7661Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables. 7662@end deftypefn 7663 7664@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align}) 7665Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode}, 7666should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of 7667constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the 7668case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment 7669in bits. 7670 7671The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic 7672constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything 7673else in @code{readonly_data_section}. 7674@end deftypefn 7675 7676@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id}) 7677Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated 7678by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be 7679the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C, 7680or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the 7681hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on 7682your target system. The default implementation of this hook just 7683returns the @var{id} provided. 7684@end deftypefn 7685 7686@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p}) 7687Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be 7688treated differently depending on something about the variable or 7689function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in). 7690 7691The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for 7692@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or 7693an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the 7694rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})} 7695in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet. 7696 7697In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is 7698a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls 7699will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global 7700register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their 7701rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is 7702leave it alone.) 7703 7704The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time 7705that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will 7706be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate 7707declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate 7708declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. 7709@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant. 7710 7711@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} 7712The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the 7713@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. 7714Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to 7715encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now 7716discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. 7717 7718The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info} 7719in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in 7720@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need 7721before overriding it. 7722@end deftypefn 7723 7724@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name}) 7725Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans 7726the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} 7727may have added. 7728@end deftypefn 7729 7730@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp}) 7731Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section. 7732The default version of this hook always returns false. 7733@end deftypefn 7734 7735@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION 7736Contains the value true if the target places read-only 7737``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false. 7738@end deftypevr 7739 7740@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void) 7741It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue. 7742 7743The default version of this hook use the target macro 7744@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}. 7745@end deftypefn 7746 7747@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp}) 7748Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution 7749rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library 7750or executable image). 7751 7752The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules 7753for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other 7754currently supported object file formats. 7755@end deftypefn 7756 7757@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS 7758Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage. 7759The default value is false. 7760@end deftypevr 7761 7762 7763@node PIC 7764@section Position Independent Code 7765@cindex position independent code 7766@cindex PIC 7767 7768This section describes macros that help implement generation of position 7769independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to 7770generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook 7771@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro 7772@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You 7773must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate 7774when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also 7775need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use 7776relative addresses. 7777@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of 7778@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93 7779 7780@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM 7781The register number of the register used to address a table of static 7782data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a 7783processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro 7784is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack 7785pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it 7786is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if 7787necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@: 7788when @code{flag_pic} is true). 7789@end defmac 7790 7791@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED 7792A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by 7793@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined, 7794the default is zero. Do not define 7795this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined. 7796@end defmac 7797 7798@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x}) 7799A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate 7800operand on the target machine when generating position independent code. 7801You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not 7802check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not 7803check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants 7804(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating 7805position independent code. 7806@end defmac 7807 7808@node Assembler Format 7809@section Defining the Output Assembler Language 7810 7811This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how 7812to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the 7813instructions do. 7814 7815@menu 7816* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file. 7817* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses). 7818* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables. 7819* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels. 7820* Initialization:: General principles of initialization 7821 and termination routines. 7822* Macros for Initialization:: 7823 Specific macros that control the handling of 7824 initialization and termination routines. 7825* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions. 7826* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables. 7827* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code. 7828* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data. 7829@end menu 7830 7831@node File Framework 7832@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File 7833@cindex assembler format 7834@cindex output of assembler code 7835 7836@c prevent bad page break with this line 7837This describes the overall framework of an assembly file. 7838 7839@findex default_file_start 7840@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void) 7841Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to 7842find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled 7843by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is 7844quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call 7845@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This 7846lets other target files rely on these variables. 7847@end deftypefn 7848 7849@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF 7850If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be 7851printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless 7852@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined 7853to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal 7854definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU 7855assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra 7856whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster. 7857 7858The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have 7859verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or 7860comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode. 7861@end deftypevr 7862 7863@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE 7864If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called 7865for the primary source file, immediately after printing 7866@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect 7867this to be done. The default is false. 7868@end deftypevr 7869 7870@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void) 7871Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects 7872to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing. 7873@end deftypefn 7874 7875@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack () 7876Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack} 7877special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on 7878the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you 7879should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you 7880need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call 7881this function. 7882@end deftypefun 7883 7884@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void) 7885Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects 7886to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output 7887nothing. 7888@end deftypefn 7889 7890@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void) 7891Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects 7892to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output 7893nothing. 7894@end deftypefn 7895 7896@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void) 7897Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting 7898unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit 7899here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file, 7900because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output 7901nothing. 7902@end deftypefn 7903 7904@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START 7905A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target 7906assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at 7907the end of the line. 7908@end defmac 7909 7910@defmac ASM_APP_ON 7911A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm} 7912statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is 7913@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most 7914assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines 7915that follow for all valid assembler constructs. 7916@end defmac 7917 7918@defmac ASM_APP_OFF 7919A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm} 7920statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is 7921@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the 7922time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output. 7923@end defmac 7924 7925@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 7926A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information 7927which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to 7928the stdio stream @var{stream}. 7929 7930This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output 7931for the file format in use is appropriate. 7932@end defmac 7933 7934@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}) 7935Output DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}. 7936 7937 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate. 7938@end deftypefn 7939 7940@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name}) 7941Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive. 7942@end deftypefn 7943 7944@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string}) 7945A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream 7946@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string} 7947in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to 7948the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format 7949of the filename using this macro. 7950@end defmac 7951 7952@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl}) 7953Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section 7954should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask 7955of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl} 7956is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which 7957this section is associated. 7958@end deftypefn 7959 7960@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num}) 7961This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter 7962code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by 7963@code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be 7964emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the 7965numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from 7966@var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the 7967normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it 7968returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence 7969is emitted. 7970@end deftypefn 7971 7972@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit}) 7973Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}. 7974Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot 7975functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only 7976at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}). 7977@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit 7978(from static destructors). 7979Return NULL if function should go to default text section. 7980@end deftypefn 7981 7982@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold}) 7983Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}. 7984@end deftypefn 7985 7986@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS 7987This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}. 7988It must not be modified by command-line option processing. 7989@end deftypevr 7990 7991@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS} 7992@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS 7993This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS 7994section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space. 7995This is true on most ELF targets. 7996@end deftypevr 7997 7998@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc}) 7999Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} 8000based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the 8001declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be 8002null, in which case read-write data should be assumed. 8003 8004The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data, 8005read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only 8006need to override this if your target has special flags that might be 8007set via @code{__attribute__}. 8008@end deftypefn 8009 8010@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text}) 8011Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line 8012switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are 8013enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded. 8014It can take the following values: 8015 8016@table @gcctabopt 8017@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED 8018@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user. 8019 8020@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED 8021@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a 8022direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by 8023default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different 8024command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables 8025various different individual optimization passes. 8026 8027@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE 8028@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be 8029ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the 8030target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first 8031time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the 8032warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for 8033wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any 8034necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to 8035perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording 8036switches. 8037 8038@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START 8039This option can be ignored by this target hook. 8040 8041@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END 8042This option can be ignored by this target hook. 8043@end table 8044 8045The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be 8046supported in the future. 8047 8048By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is 8049provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches}, 8050it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable 8051section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is 8052provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target 8053hook. 8054@end deftypefn 8055 8056@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION 8057This is the name of the section that will be created by the example 8058ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target 8059hook. 8060@end deftypevr 8061 8062@need 2000 8063@node Data Output 8064@subsection Output of Data 8065 8066 8067@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP 8068@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP 8069@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PSI_OP 8070@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP 8071@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PDI_OP 8072@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP 8073@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PTI_OP 8074@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP 8075@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP 8076@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PSI_OP 8077@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP 8078@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PDI_OP 8079@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP 8080@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PTI_OP 8081@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP 8082These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds 8083of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a 8084byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an 8085aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be 8086@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available. 8087 8088The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line, 8089followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases, 8090the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab. 8091@end deftypevr 8092 8093@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p}) 8094The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an 8095integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size 8096in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The 8097function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the 8098object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to 8099split the object into smaller parts. 8100 8101The default implementation of this hook will use the 8102@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false} 8103when the relevant string is @code{NULL}. 8104@end deftypefn 8105 8106@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void) 8107Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to 8108terminate an initialized variable declaration. 8109@end deftypefn 8110 8111@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x}) 8112A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const} 8113can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to 8114the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent 8115@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants. 8116 8117If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false}, 8118so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message 8119itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just 8120return @code{true}. 8121@end deftypefn 8122 8123@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len}) 8124A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler 8125instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len} 8126bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type 8127@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}. 8128 8129If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the 8130Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro 8131@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}. 8132@end defmac 8133 8134@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n}) 8135A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for 8136@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS} 8137is defined, and is otherwise unused. 8138@end defmac 8139 8140@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION 8141You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the 8142expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant 8143pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if 8144GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do 8145not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant 8146pool before the function. 8147@end defmac 8148 8149@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size}) 8150A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the 8151constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving 8152the name of the function. Should the return type of the function 8153be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} 8154is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written 8155immediately after this call. 8156 8157If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need 8158not be defined. 8159@end defmac 8160 8161@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto}) 8162A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the 8163constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do 8164anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.) 8165 8166The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the 8167assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to 8168output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a 8169@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value 8170@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much 8171alignment. 8172 8173The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for 8174the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is 8175responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place. 8176Here is how to do this: 8177 8178@smallexample 8179@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno}); 8180@end smallexample 8181 8182When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a 8183@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool 8184entry from being output a second time in the usual manner. 8185 8186You need not define this macro if it would do nothing. 8187@end defmac 8188 8189@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size}) 8190A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant 8191pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the 8192function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can 8193obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the 8194constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call. 8195 8196If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not 8197define this macro. 8198@end defmac 8199 8200@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR}) 8201Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is 8202used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points 8203to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if 8204a line separator uses multiple characters. 8205 8206If you do not define this macro, the default is that only 8207the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator. 8208@end defmac 8209 8210@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN 8211@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN 8212These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the 8213assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they 8214default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers. 8215@end deftypevr 8216 8217These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions 8218of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like: 8219 8220@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l}) 8221@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l}) 8222@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l}) 8223@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l}) 8224@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l}) 8225@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l}) 8226These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the 8227target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in 8228the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and 8229@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a 8230simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of 8231@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined 8232by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of 8233it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds 823432 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits 8235on the host machine. 8236 8237The array element values are designed so that you can print them out 8238using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target 8239machine's memory. 8240@end defmac 8241 8242@node Uninitialized Data 8243@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables 8244 8245Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of 8246outputting a single uninitialized variable. 8247 8248@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded}) 8249A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8250@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named 8251@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded} 8252is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is 8253possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no 8254other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the 8255backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one 8256byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare 8257equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express 8258the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent 8259an ordinary undefined external. 8260 8261Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to 8262output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional 8263assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. 8264 8265This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized 8266common global variables are output. 8267@end defmac 8268 8269@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment}) 8270Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a 8271separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in 8272place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in 8273handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified 8274as the number of bits. 8275@end defmac 8276 8277@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment}) 8278Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the 8279variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there 8280is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it 8281in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and 8282@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see 8283the variable's decl in order to chose what to output. 8284@end defmac 8285 8286@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment}) 8287A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8288@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named 8289@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment} 8290is the alignment specified as the number of bits. 8291 8292Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file 8293@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression 8294@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself; 8295before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining 8296the name, and a newline. 8297 8298There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro. 8299The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a 8300switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}). 8301You do not need to do both. 8302 8303Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a 8304non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals 8305efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does 8306not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals 8307common in order to save space in the object file. 8308@end defmac 8309 8310@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded}) 8311A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8312@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named 8313@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded} 8314is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. 8315 8316Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to 8317output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional 8318assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. 8319 8320This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized 8321static variables are output. 8322@end defmac 8323 8324@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment}) 8325Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a 8326separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in 8327place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in 8328handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified 8329as the number of bits. 8330@end defmac 8331 8332@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment}) 8333Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the 8334variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there 8335is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it 8336in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and 8337@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see 8338the variable's decl in order to chose what to output. 8339@end defmac 8340 8341@node Label Output 8342@subsection Output and Generation of Labels 8343 8344@c prevent bad page break with this line 8345This is about outputting labels. 8346 8347@findex assemble_name 8348@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 8349A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8350@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}. 8351Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to 8352output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional 8353assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default 8354definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems. 8355@end defmac 8356 8357@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl}) 8358A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8359@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of 8360a function. 8361Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to 8362output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional 8363assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default 8364definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems. 8365 8366If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the 8367usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). 8368@end defmac 8369 8370@findex assemble_name_raw 8371@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 8372Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known 8373to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses 8374@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except 8375that it is more efficient. 8376@end defmac 8377 8378@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP 8379A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the 8380size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the 8381default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other 8382systems, the default is not to define this macro. 8383 8384Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions 8385of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} 8386for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those 8387macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not 8388define this macro. 8389@end defmac 8390 8391@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}) 8392A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8393@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the 8394symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}. 8395If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is 8396provided. 8397@end defmac 8398 8399@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 8400A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8401@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of 8402the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current 8403address. 8404 8405If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is 8406provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special 8407@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate 8408the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does 8409not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need 8410to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique. 8411@end defmac 8412 8413@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL 8414Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character 8415@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in 8416G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined, 8417@samp{.} is used instead. 8418@end defmac 8419 8420@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL 8421Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character 8422@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++ 8423have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names 8424are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}. 8425@end defmac 8426 8427@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP 8428A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the 8429type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the 8430default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other 8431systems, the default is not to define this macro. 8432 8433Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of 8434@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own 8435custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol 8436types at all, do not define this macro. 8437@end defmac 8438 8439@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT 8440A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of 8441the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the 8442default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems, 8443the default is not to define this macro. 8444 8445Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of 8446@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own 8447custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol 8448types at all, do not define this macro. 8449@end defmac 8450 8451@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type}) 8452A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8453@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the 8454symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently, 8455that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but 8456you should not count on this. 8457 8458If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default 8459definition of this macro is provided. 8460@end defmac 8461 8462@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl}) 8463A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8464@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a 8465function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for 8466outputting the label definition (perhaps using 8467@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the 8468@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function. 8469 8470If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the 8471usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). 8472 8473You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition 8474of this macro. 8475@end defmac 8476 8477@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl}) 8478A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8479@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function 8480which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the 8481function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node 8482representing the function. 8483 8484If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined. 8485 8486You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition 8487of this macro. 8488@end defmac 8489 8490@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl}) 8491A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8492@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a 8493cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible 8494for outputting the label definition (perhaps using 8495@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the 8496@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function. 8497 8498If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the 8499usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). 8500 8501You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition 8502of this macro. 8503@end defmac 8504 8505@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl}) 8506A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8507@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function 8508partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the 8509cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the 8510@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function. 8511 8512If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined. 8513 8514You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition 8515of this macro. 8516@end defmac 8517 8518@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl}) 8519A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8520@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an 8521initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the 8522label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument 8523@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable. 8524 8525If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the 8526usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). 8527 8528You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or 8529@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro. 8530@end defmac 8531 8532@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}) 8533A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary 8534for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This 8535target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using 8536@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant, 8537and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name} 8538will be an internal label. 8539 8540The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the 8541usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}). 8542 8543You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook. 8544@end deftypefn 8545 8546@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name}) 8547A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8548@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno} 8549for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}. 8550 8551If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do 8552nothing. 8553@end defmac 8554 8555@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend}) 8556A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name 8557once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a 8558chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an 8559initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare 8560something about the size of the object. 8561 8562If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do 8563nothing. 8564 8565You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or 8566@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro. 8567@end defmac 8568 8569@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}) 8570This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream 8571@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global; 8572that is, available for reference from other files. 8573 8574The default implementation relies on a proper definition of 8575@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}. 8576@end deftypefn 8577 8578@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}) 8579This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream 8580@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl} 8581global; that is, available for reference from other files. 8582 8583The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook. 8584@end deftypefn 8585 8586@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl}) 8587This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream 8588@var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with 8589@var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most 8590assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case. 8591@end deftypefn 8592 8593@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 8594A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8595@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak; 8596that is, available for reference from other files but only used if 8597no other definition is available. Use the expression 8598@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name 8599itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax 8600for making that name weak, and a newline. 8601 8602If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not 8603support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} 8604macro. 8605@end defmac 8606 8607@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value}) 8608Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and 8609@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function 8610or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement 8611should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which 8612defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value 8613@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands 8614to make @var{name} weak. 8615@end defmac 8616 8617@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value}) 8618Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to 8619symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the 8620declaration of @code{name}. 8621@end defmac 8622 8623@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK 8624A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target 8625supports weak symbols. 8626 8627If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default 8628definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL} 8629is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. 8630@end defmac 8631 8632@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK 8633A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols. 8634 8635If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default 8636definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define 8637this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler 8638flag such as @option{-melf}. 8639@end defmac 8640 8641@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl}) 8642A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a 8643public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will 8644be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file 8645format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT} 8646section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support 8647requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section. 8648@end defmac 8649 8650@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY 8651A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only 8652semantics. 8653 8654If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default 8655definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default 8656definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if 8657you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if 8658setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to 8659be emitted as one-only. 8660@end defmac 8661 8662@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility}) 8663This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some 8664commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have 8665hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}. 8666@end deftypefn 8667 8668@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC 8669A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects 8670that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents. 8671The default is @code{0}. 8672 8673Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that, 8674if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and 8675will have undefined references from other translation units, that 8676symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will 8677thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak 8678(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes 8679with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak. 8680 8681The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for 8682targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker 8683restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's 8684table of contents. 8685@end defmac 8686 8687@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}) 8688A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8689@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external 8690symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but 8691not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the 8692declaration. 8693 8694This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything. 8695The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything. 8696@end defmac 8697 8698@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref}) 8699This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler 8700pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the 8701library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}. 8702@end deftypefn 8703 8704@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol}) 8705This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler 8706directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the 8707.no_dead_code_strip directive. 8708@end deftypefn 8709 8710@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 8711A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream 8712@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named 8713@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that 8714is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix 8715systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}. 8716@end defmac 8717 8718@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name}) 8719Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any. 8720@end deftypefn 8721 8722@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym}) 8723A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to 8724@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name} 8725will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used 8726to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information 8727encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}. 8728@end defmac 8729 8730@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf}) 8731A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the 8732result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined, 8733@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol. 8734This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l} 8735specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set 8736when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is 8737being taken. 8738@end defmac 8739 8740@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno}) 8741A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose 8742name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}. 8743 8744It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels 8745used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs 8746will have name conflicts with internal labels. 8747 8748It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the 8749object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that 8750should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the 8751beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what 8752convention your system uses, and follow it. 8753 8754The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. 8755@end deftypefn 8756 8757@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}) 8758A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info 8759label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number 8760@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels 8761may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some 8762systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction 8763bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction 8764bundles. 8765 8766If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be 8767used. 8768@end defmac 8769 8770@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}) 8771A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name 8772is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}. 8773 8774This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should 8775produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce 8776with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}. 8777 8778If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will 8779output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for 8780@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the 8781string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets 8782to output the string, and may change it. (Of course, 8783@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so 8784you should know what it does on your machine.) 8785@end defmac 8786 8787@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number}) 8788A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type 8789@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string 8790@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation 8791added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string. 8792 8793The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to 8794produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is 8795@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid 8796assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this 8797macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named 8798internal static variables in different scopes. 8799 8800Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any 8801conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods 8802or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these 8803between the name and the number will suffice. 8804 8805If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided 8806which is correct for most systems. 8807@end defmac 8808 8809@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value}) 8810A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code 8811which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}. 8812 8813@findex SET_ASM_OP 8814If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is 8815correct for most systems. 8816@end defmac 8817 8818@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value}) 8819A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code 8820which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} 8821to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will 8822be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if 8823the tree nodes are available. 8824 8825@findex SET_ASM_OP 8826If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is 8827correct for most systems. 8828@end defmac 8829 8830@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value}) 8831A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines 8832(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value 8833of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the 8834current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines. 8835This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and 8836@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}. 8837@end defmac 8838 8839@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value}) 8840A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code 8841which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value 8842@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as 8843an undefined weak symbol. 8844 8845Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define 8846@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible. 8847@end defmac 8848 8849@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name}) 8850Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for 8851Objective-C methods. 8852 8853The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the 8854class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of 8855the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@: 8856@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}). 8857 8858These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since 8859the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular 8860systems define other ways of computing names. 8861 8862@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a 8863buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as 8864@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus 886550 characters extra. 8866 8867The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance 8868method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class; 8869@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not 8870in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector. 8871 8872On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this 8873macro to provide more human-readable names. 8874@end defmac 8875 8876@node Initialization 8877@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled 8878@cindex initialization routines 8879@cindex termination routines 8880@cindex constructors, output of 8881@cindex destructors, output of 8882 8883The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors} 8884(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize 8885data in the program when the program is started. These functions need 8886to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before 8887@code{main} is called. 8888 8889Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called 8890@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program 8891terminates. 8892 8893To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler 8894must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to 8895be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new 8896system, you need to specify how to do this. 8897 8898There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of 8899initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants. 8900Much of the structure is common to all four variations. 8901 8902@findex __CTOR_LIST__ 8903@findex __DTOR_LIST__ 8904The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of 8905initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of 8906termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}. 8907 8908Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold 89090, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on 8910the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function 8911pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function 8912pointer containing zero. 8913 8914Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either 8915@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup 8916time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the 8917list; destructors in forward order. 8918 8919The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file 8920formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set 8921aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors. 8922Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each 8923object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in 8924the constructor section to point to that function. The linker 8925accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section. 8926Termination functions are handled similarly. 8927 8928This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if 8929@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not 8930support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated 8931constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} 8932and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect. 8933 8934When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending 8935upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that 8936support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup, 8937parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The 8938program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this: 8939 8940@smallexample 8941ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o 8942@end smallexample 8943 8944The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init} 8945section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise 8946for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these 8947files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but 8948are provided by GCC for a few targets. 8949 8950The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets) 8951compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code 8952fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch 8953to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts 8954of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function 8955that invokes the routines we need at startup. 8956 8957To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} 8958macro properly. 8959 8960If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called 8961@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program 8962entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}), 8963it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code 8964after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined 8965in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors. 8966 8967In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again 8968two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld}) 8969and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case, 8970@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs} 8971entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, 8972and with the address of the void function containing the initialization 8973code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add 8974the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually 8975placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with 8976a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element. 8977@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init 8978section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes 8979the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting 8980the initialization process. 8981 8982The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker. 8983This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using 8984file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In 8985this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and 8986termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires 8987an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program 8988pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running 8989the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of 8990initialization and termination functions. These functions are called 8991via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method, 8992@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}. 8993 8994@ifinfo 8995The following section describes the specific macros that control and 8996customize the handling of initialization and termination functions. 8997@end ifinfo 8998 8999@node Macros for Initialization 9000@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines 9001 9002Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization 9003and termination functions: 9004 9005@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP 9006If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler 9007operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not 9008defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are 9009using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this 9010macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to 9011run the initialization functions. 9012@end defmac 9013 9014@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION 9015If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above. 9016This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code 9017on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not 9018be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. 9019@end defmac 9020 9021@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH 9022If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that 9023the following symbol is an initialization routine. 9024@end defmac 9025 9026@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH 9027If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that 9028the following symbol is a finalization routine. 9029@end defmac 9030 9031@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func}) 9032If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be 9033automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function 9034should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and 9035the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a 9036function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated. 9037 9038This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a 9039shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2 9040exception tables embedded in the code. 9041@end defmac 9042 9043@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func}) 9044If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be 9045automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function 9046should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and 9047the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a 9048function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated. 9049@end defmac 9050 9051@defmac INVOKE__main 9052If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of 9053@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems 9054where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still 9055useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors. 9056@end defmac 9057 9058@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY 9059If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the 9060compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization 9061of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon 9062encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute. 9063@end defmac 9064 9065@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS 9066This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of 9067collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit. 9068It is false if we must use @command{collect2}. 9069@end deftypevr 9070 9071@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority}) 9072If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call 9073the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time. 9074 9075Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking 9076no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization 9077priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY}; 9078otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}. 9079 9080If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will 9081be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the 9082target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2} 9083is not defined. 9084@end deftypefn 9085 9086@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority}) 9087This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination 9088functions rather than initialization functions. 9089@end deftypefn 9090 9091If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine 9092generated for the generated object file will have static linkage. 9093 9094If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing 9095constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan 9096an object file for constructor functions to be called. 9097 9098On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make 9099@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all): 9100 9101@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF 9102Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format) 9103object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan 9104object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions. 9105 9106This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as 9107part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine. 9108@end defmac 9109 9110@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME 9111Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use 9112to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for 9113@command{nm}. 9114@end defmac 9115 9116@defmac NM_FLAGS 9117@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static 9118constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is 9119passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options 9120are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n} 9121produces. 9122@end defmac 9123 9124If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the 9125dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define 9126these macros to enable support for running initialization and 9127termination functions in shared libraries: 9128 9129@defmac LDD_SUFFIX 9130Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program 9131which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4. 9132@end defmac 9133 9134@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr}) 9135Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output 9136of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable 9137of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output 9138from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the 9139code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that 9140line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}. 9141@end defmac 9142 9143@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX 9144Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared 9145library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2} 9146strips version information after this suffix when generating global 9147constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets 9148that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors. 9149@end defmac 9150 9151@node Instruction Output 9152@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions 9153 9154@c prevent bad page break with this line 9155This describes assembler instruction output. 9156 9157@defmac REGISTER_NAMES 9158A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine 9159registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates 9160register numbers in the compiler into assembler language. 9161@end defmac 9162 9163@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES 9164If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name 9165and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard 9166registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer 9167to registers using alternate names. 9168@end defmac 9169 9170@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES 9171If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a 9172name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive 9173machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional 9174names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in 9175declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike 9176@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the 9177register name implies multiple underlying registers. 9178 9179This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an 9180@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the 9181register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision 9182VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers 9183``s0'' and ``s1''. 9184@end defmac 9185 9186@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}) 9187Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that 9188requires different names for the machine instructions. 9189 9190The definition is a C statement or statements which output an 9191assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The 9192macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which 9193points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is 9194written in the machine description. The definition should output the 9195opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and 9196increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode 9197so that it will not be output twice. 9198 9199In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode 9200name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text 9201that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take 9202care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment 9203@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally. 9204 9205@findex recog_data.operand 9206If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the 9207elements of @code{recog_data.operand}. 9208 9209If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output 9210in the usual way. 9211@end defmac 9212 9213@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands}) 9214If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of 9215assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so 9216they will be output differently. 9217 9218Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands 9219extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of 9220elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn. 9221The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn 9222template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output 9223by changing the contents of the vector. 9224 9225This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single 9226file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you 9227can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such 9228as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler 9229syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by 9230writing conditional output routines in those patterns. 9231 9232If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement. 9233@end defmac 9234 9235@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands}) 9236If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the 9237output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler 9238if necessary. 9239 9240Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands 9241extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of 9242elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn. 9243The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn 9244template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode 9245by checking the contents of the vector. 9246@end deftypefn 9247 9248@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code}) 9249A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the 9250assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an 9251RTL expression. 9252 9253@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways 9254of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be 9255printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from 9256the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the 9257operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then 9258@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr} 9259@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}. 9260 9261@findex reg_names 9262If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name. 9263The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is 9264@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from 9265@code{REGISTER_NAMES}. 9266 9267When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}} 9268(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called 9269with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for 9270@var{code}. 9271@end defmac 9272 9273@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code}) 9274A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid 9275punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If 9276@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no 9277punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used 9278in this way. 9279@end defmac 9280 9281@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x}) 9282A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the 9283assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference 9284whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression. 9285 9286@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage 9287On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the 9288section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook 9289@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the 9290@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler 9291Format}. 9292@end defmac 9293 9294@findex dbr_sequence_length 9295@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file}) 9296A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have 9297been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to 9298determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not 9299currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output, 9300or whatever. 9301 9302Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in 9303reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made 9304explicit (e.g.@: with white space). 9305@end defmac 9306 9307@findex final_sequence 9308Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be 9309prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence 9310(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be 9311found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not 9312processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx 9313being output. 9314 9315@findex asm_fprintf 9316@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX 9317@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX 9318@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX 9319@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX 9320If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L}, 9321@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see 9322@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must 9323support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h} 9324files can define these macros differently. 9325@end defmac 9326 9327@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format}) 9328If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case} 9329statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of 9330the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra 9331printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler 9332statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future 9333generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target 9334specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}. 9335The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format 9336string, starting the character after the one that is being switched 9337upon, is pointed to by @var{format}. 9338@end defmac 9339 9340@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT 9341If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as 9342different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the 9343numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the 9344first variant. 9345 9346If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form 9347@smallexample 9348@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}} 9349@end smallexample 9350@noindent 9351in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the 9352first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs 9353@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of 9354@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters 9355within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer 9356alternatives within the braces than the value of 9357@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed 9358to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly, 9359@samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used. 9360 9361If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and 9362@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or 9363operands to @code{asm_fprintf}. 9364 9365Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX}, 9366@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express 9367the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define 9368@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax 9369if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different 9370opcodes or operand order. 9371@end defmac 9372 9373@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno}) 9374A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code 9375which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack. 9376The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when 9377profiling. 9378@end defmac 9379 9380@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno}) 9381A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code 9382which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack. 9383The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when 9384profiling. 9385@end defmac 9386 9387@node Dispatch Tables 9388@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables 9389 9390@c prevent bad page break with this line 9391This concerns dispatch tables. 9392 9393@cindex dispatch table 9394@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel}) 9395A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler 9396pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels. 9397@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The 9398definitions of these labels are output using 9399@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same 9400way here. For example, 9401 9402@smallexample 9403fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n", 9404 @var{value}, @var{rel}) 9405@end smallexample 9406 9407You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a 9408dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC 9409will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@. 9410@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the 9411mode and flags can be read. 9412@end defmac 9413 9414@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value}) 9415This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses 9416in a dispatch table are absolute. 9417 9418The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream 9419@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to 9420a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose 9421definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}. 9422For example, 9423 9424@smallexample 9425fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value}) 9426@end smallexample 9427@end defmac 9428 9429@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table}) 9430Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output 9431specially. The first three arguments are the same as for 9432@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the 9433jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an 9434@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}). 9435 9436This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement 9437for the table. 9438 9439If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with 9440@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}. 9441@end defmac 9442 9443@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table}) 9444Define this if something special must be output at the end of a 9445jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed 9446after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write 9447the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument 9448@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number 9449of the preceding label. 9450 9451If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of 9452the jump-table. 9453@end defmac 9454 9455@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_POST_CFI_STARTPROC (FILE *@var{}, @var{tree}) 9456This target hook is used to emit assembly strings required by the target 9457after the .cfi_startproc directive. The first argument is the file stream to 9458write the strings to and the second argument is the function's declaration. The 9459expected use is to add more .cfi_* directives. 9460 9461The default is to not output any assembly strings. 9462@end deftypefn 9463 9464@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty}) 9465This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It 9466should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it 9467should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the 9468function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}. 9469The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an 9470exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean: 9471true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@. 9472 9473The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels. 9474@end deftypefn 9475 9476@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}) 9477This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table. 9478It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table 9479to be broken up according to function. 9480 9481The default is that no label is emitted. 9482@end deftypefn 9483 9484@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality}) 9485If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used. 9486@end deftypefn 9487 9488@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}) 9489This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the 9490given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO} 9491returns @code{UI_TARGET}. 9492@end deftypefn 9493 9494@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN 9495True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward. 9496@end deftypevr 9497 9498@node Exception Region Output 9499@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions 9500 9501@c prevent bad page break with this line 9502 9503This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception 9504region. 9505 9506@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME 9507If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing 9508exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will 9509provide a default definition if the target supports named sections. 9510@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section. 9511 9512You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame 9513unwind information and the default definition does not work. 9514@end defmac 9515 9516@defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2 9517If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by 9518specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these 9519labels and generate code to register the frames. 9520 9521This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not 9522place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c}, 9523or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot 9524be marked as not to be collected. 9525@end defmac 9526 9527@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY 9528Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind 9529information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a 9530runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only 9531and read-write sections into a single read-write section. 9532@end defmac 9533 9534@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR 9535An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so 9536that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it. 9537@end defmac 9538 9539@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO 9540Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind 9541information, but it does not yet work with exception handling. 9542Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines 9543@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), 9544GCC will provide a default definition of 1. 9545@end defmac 9546 9547@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}) 9548This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling 9549by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook 9550should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the 9551@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook 9552should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind 9553information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}. 9554 9555A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}. 9556This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The 9557default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}. 9558 9559Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should 9560not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by 9561@var{opts}. In particular, the 9562setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor 9563macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up 9564depending on this setting. 9565 9566The default implementation of the hook first honors the 9567@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then 9568@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If 9569@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target 9570must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly. 9571@end deftypefn 9572 9573@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT 9574This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding 9575tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by 9576command-line option processing. 9577@end deftypevr 9578 9579@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP 9580Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme 9581should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library 9582instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery. 9583@end defmac 9584 9585@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE 9586This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also 9587defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer 9588for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism 9589is not large enough, or if it is much too large. 9590The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}. 9591@end defmac 9592 9593@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT 9594This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the 9595function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to 9596@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum 9597alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive 9598minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{DWARF}. Only applicable if 9599the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information. 9600@end defmac 9601 9602@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO 9603Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the 9604end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling. 9605Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and 9606true otherwise. 9607@end deftypevr 9608 9609@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg}) 9610Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to 9611represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the 9612register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous 9613locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one 9614register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}. 9615If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}. 9616@end deftypefn 9617 9618@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno}) 9619Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the 9620corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally 9621used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call 9622clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size 9623@end deftypefn 9624 9625@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address}) 9626If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in 9627multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the 9628sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime. 9629It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after 9630filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register; 9631@var{address} is the address of the table. 9632@end deftypefn 9633 9634@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym}) 9635This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to 9636the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true} 9637if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the 9638reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines. 9639@end deftypefn 9640 9641@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER 9642This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI 9643based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects 9644the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after 9645running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}. 9646@end deftypevr 9647 9648@node Alignment Output 9649@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment 9650 9651@c prevent bad page break with this line 9652This describes commands for alignment. 9653 9654@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label}) 9655The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is 9656a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge. 9657 9658This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment 9659to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently 9660define the macro. 9661 9662Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better 9663to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's 9664@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's 9665selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation. 9666@end defmac 9667 9668@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label}) 9669The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows 9670a @code{BARRIER}. 9671 9672This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment 9673to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently 9674define the macro. 9675@end defmac 9676 9677@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label}) 9678The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads 9679a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop). 9680 9681This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment 9682to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently 9683define the macro. 9684 9685Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better 9686to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's 9687@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's 9688selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation. 9689@end defmac 9690 9691@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label}) 9692The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}. 9693If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment, 9694the maximum of the specified values is used. 9695 9696Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better 9697to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's 9698@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's 9699selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation. 9700@end defmac 9701 9702@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes}) 9703A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler 9704instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes. 9705Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C 9706expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}. 9707@end defmac 9708 9709@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT 9710Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the 9711text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped. 9712This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes 9713produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text 9714section. 9715@end defmac 9716 9717@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}) 9718A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler 9719command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the 9720@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}. 9721@end defmac 9722 9723@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power}) 9724Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used 9725for padding, if necessary. 9726@end defmac 9727 9728@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip}) 9729A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler 9730command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the 9731@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to 9732satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be 9733a C expression of type @code{int}. 9734@end defmac 9735 9736@need 3000 9737@node Debugging Info 9738@section Controlling Debugging Information Format 9739 9740@c prevent bad page break with this line 9741This describes how to specify debugging information. 9742 9743@menu 9744* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly. 9745* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format. 9746* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format. 9747* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format. 9748* DWARF:: Macros for DWARF format. 9749* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format. 9750@end menu 9751 9752@node All Debuggers 9753@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats 9754 9755@c prevent bad page break with this line 9756These macros affect all debugging formats. 9757 9758@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno}) 9759A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler 9760register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value 9761of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are 9762some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice 9763versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the 9764compiler and another for DBX@. 9765 9766If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be 9767used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have 9768consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}. 9769Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they 9770expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme. 9771 9772If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that 9773does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is 9774redefine the actual register numbering scheme. 9775@end defmac 9776 9777@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x}) 9778A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic 9779variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default 9780computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and 9781gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets 9782that produce debugging output for DBX and allow the frame-pointer to be 9783eliminated when the @option{-g} option is used. 9784@end defmac 9785 9786@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x}) 9787A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument 9788having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is 9789@var{offset}. 9790@end defmac 9791 9792@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE 9793A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should 9794produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define 9795this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of 9796debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG}, 9797@code{DWARF2_DEBUG}, @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, 9798and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}. 9799 9800When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the 9801value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two 9802exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the 9803value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is 9804defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}. 9805 9806The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the 9807user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs}, 9808@option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}. 9809@end defmac 9810 9811@node DBX Options 9812@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output 9813 9814@c prevent bad page break with this line 9815These are specific options for DBX output. 9816 9817@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO 9818Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX 9819in response to the @option{-g} option. 9820@end defmac 9821 9822@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 9823Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output 9824in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format. 9825@end defmac 9826 9827@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS 9828Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate 9829GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format 9830debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the 9831macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information 9832if there is any occasion to. 9833@end defmac 9834 9835@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT 9836Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while 9837in the text section. 9838@end defmac 9839 9840@defmac ASM_STABS_OP 9841A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to 9842use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol. 9843If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro 9844applies only to DBX debugging information format. 9845@end defmac 9846 9847@defmac ASM_STABD_OP 9848A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to 9849use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose 9850value is the current location. If you don't define this macro, 9851@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging 9852information format. 9853@end defmac 9854 9855@defmac ASM_STABN_OP 9856A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to 9857use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no 9858name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This 9859macro applies only to DBX debugging information format. 9860@end defmac 9861 9862@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS 9863Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct 9864@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to 9865describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}. 9866On other systems, this construct is not supported at all. 9867@end defmac 9868 9869@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH 9870A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally 9871continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it 9872exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some 9873operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting 9874must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro 9875with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by 9876defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire. 9877@end defmac 9878 9879@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR 9880Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to 9881the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use 9882a different character instead, define this macro as a character 9883constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro 9884if backslash is correct for your system. 9885@end defmac 9886 9887@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION 9888Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before 9889outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static 9890variable. 9891@end defmac 9892 9893@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE 9894The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive 9895for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}. 9896@end defmac 9897 9898@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE 9899The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive 9900for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not 9901provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}. 9902@end defmac 9903 9904@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE 9905The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive 9906for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any 9907``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}. 9908@end defmac 9909 9910@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER 9911The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter 9912passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to 9913do this. The default is @code{'P'}. 9914@end defmac 9915 9916@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST 9917Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its 9918arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally, 9919in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler 9920code. 9921@end defmac 9922 9923@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE 9924Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing 9925the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be 9926relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses 9927an absolute address. 9928@end defmac 9929 9930@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE 9931Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating 9932the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the 9933start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address. 9934@end defmac 9935 9936@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL 9937Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and 9938@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This 9939macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file 9940number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not 9941generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single 9942number for a type number. 9943@end defmac 9944 9945@node DBX Hooks 9946@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format 9947 9948@c prevent bad page break with this line 9949These are hooks for DBX format. 9950 9951@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter}) 9952A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line 9953number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream 9954@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was 9955invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate 9956unique labels in the assembly output. 9957 9958This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or 9959if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}. 9960@end defmac 9961 9962@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END 9963Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the 9964@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct. 9965On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without 9966disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions. 9967@end defmac 9968 9969@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM 9970Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx 9971extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this 9972feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions. 9973@end defmac 9974 9975@node File Names and DBX 9976@subsection File Names in DBX Format 9977 9978@c prevent bad page break with this line 9979This describes file names in DBX format. 9980 9981@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 9982A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream 9983@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source 9984file---the file specified as the input file for compilation. 9985This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation. 9986 9987This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output 9988for DBX debugging information is appropriate. 9989 9990It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the 9991text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)} 9992to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable 9993@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}. 9994@end defmac 9995 9996@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY 9997Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication 9998of the current directory for compilation and current source language at 9999the beginning of the file. 10000@end defmac 10001 10002@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER 10003Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication 10004that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit 10005an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with 10006@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0. 10007@end defmac 10008 10009@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name}) 10010A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of 10011compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be 10012written to the stdio stream @var{stream}. 10013 10014If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end 10015of compilation, which is correct for most machines. 10016@end defmac 10017 10018@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END 10019Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining 10020@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at 10021the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string, 10022whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file. 10023@end defmac 10024 10025@need 2000 10026@node DWARF 10027@subsection Macros for DWARF Output 10028 10029@c prevent bad page break with this line 10030Here are macros for DWARF output. 10031 10032@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO 10033Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format 10034debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option. 10035 10036@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function}) 10037Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to 10038be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum 10039value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag. 10040@end deftypefn 10041 10042To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also 10043define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set 10044@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the 10045prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save} 10046as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't. 10047@end defmac 10048 10049@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 10050Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output 10051Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO} 10052(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and 10053exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter 10054how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}. 10055@end defmac 10056 10057@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void) 10058This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame 10059unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return 10060@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and 10061return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise. 10062 10063A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information 10064is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information. 10065 10066A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables. 10067This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information. 10068@end deftypefn 10069 10070@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 10071Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2 10072line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number 10073tables, and hence is desirable if it works. 10074@end defmac 10075 10076@defmac DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO 10077Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler supports view 10078assignment and verification in @code{.loc}. If it does not, but the 10079user enables location views, the compiler may have to fallback to 10080internal line number tables. 10081@end defmac 10082 10083@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RESET_LOCATION_VIEW (rtx_insn *@var{}) 10084This hook, if defined, enables -ginternal-reset-location-views, and 10085uses its result to override cases in which the estimated min insn 10086length might be nonzero even when a PC advance (i.e., a view reset) 10087cannot be taken for granted. 10088 10089If the hook is defined, it must return a positive value to indicate 10090the insn definitely advances the PC, and so the view number can be 10091safely assumed to be reset; a negative value to mean the insn 10092definitely does not advance the PC, and os the view number must not 10093be reset; or zero to decide based on the estimated insn length. 10094 10095If insn length is to be regarded as reliable, set the hook to 10096@code{hook_int_rtx_insn_0}. 10097@end deftypefn 10098 10099@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS 10100True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them. 10101@end deftypevr 10102 10103@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2 10104True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. 10105This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg. 10106@end deftypevr 10107 10108@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK 10109True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. 10110This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg. 10111@end deftypevr 10112 10113@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION 10114True if register allocation and the passes 10115following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler 10116targets. 10117@end deftypevr 10118 10119@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2}) 10120A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference 10121@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}. 10122@end defmac 10123 10124@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2}) 10125A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference 10126between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g.@: instruction 10127slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size. 10128@end defmac 10129 10130@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section}) 10131A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a 10132section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using 10133an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the 10134given @var{section}. 10135@end defmac 10136 10137@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}) 10138A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative 10139reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}. 10140@end defmac 10141 10142@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}) 10143A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the 10144given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}. 10145@end defmac 10146 10147@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label}) 10148A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to 10149the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This 10150is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which 10151is referenced by a function. 10152@end defmac 10153 10154@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x}) 10155If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative 10156reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size. 10157@end deftypefn 10158 10159@need 2000 10160@node VMS Debug 10161@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format 10162 10163@c prevent bad page break with this line 10164Here are macros for VMS debug format. 10165 10166@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO 10167Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS 10168in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS 10169is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of 10170@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This 10171behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and 10172@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. 10173@end defmac 10174 10175@node Floating Point 10176@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point 10177@cindex cross compilation and floating point 10178@cindex floating point and cross compilation 10179 10180While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers, 10181there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This 10182means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers 10183in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine 10184doing the compilation. 10185 10186Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of 10187range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in 10188the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot 10189safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate 10190the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses 10191emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and 10192target floating point formats are identical. 10193 10194The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to 10195use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize 10196floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate 10197their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects. 10198 10199@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE 10200The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target 10201machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an 10202array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque 10203quantity. 10204@end defmac 10205 10206@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}) 10207Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero. 10208@end deftypefn 10209 10210@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}) 10211Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If 10212@var{x} is negative, returns zero. 10213@end deftypefn 10214 10215@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode}) 10216Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's 10217representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both 10218decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax 10219defined by the C language for both. 10220@end deftypefn 10221 10222@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}) 10223Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise. 10224@end deftypefn 10225 10226@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}) 10227Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative). 10228@end deftypefn 10229 10230@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}) 10231Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number). 10232@end deftypefn 10233 10234@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}) 10235Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}. 10236@end deftypefn 10237 10238@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}) 10239Returns the absolute value of @var{x}. 10240@end deftypefn 10241 10242@node Mode Switching 10243@section Mode Switching Instructions 10244@cindex mode switching 10245The following macros control mode switching optimizations: 10246 10247@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity}) 10248Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode 10249switching in an optimizing compilation. 10250 10251For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision 10252floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation, 10253the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision 10254operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general 10255purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to 10256be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you cannot put this into instruction emitting 10257or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}. 10258 10259You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time 10260which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should 10261return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching. 10262If you define this macro, you also have to define 10263@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED}, 10264@code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}. 10265@code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} 10266are optional. 10267@end defmac 10268 10269@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING 10270If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as 10271initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element 10272N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number 10273of different modes that might need to be set for this entity. 10274The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at 10275zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched 10276entity in question. 10277In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are 10278represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode 10279switch is needed / supplied. 10280@end defmac 10281 10282@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live}) 10283Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority. 10284@end deftypefn 10285 10286@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}) 10287@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}. 10288@end deftypefn 10289 10290@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}) 10291@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode). 10292@end deftypefn 10293 10294@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity}) 10295If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined. 10296@end deftypefn 10297 10298@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity}) 10299If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined. 10300@end deftypefn 10301 10302@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n}) 10303This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}. 10304@end deftypefn 10305 10306@node Target Attributes 10307@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__} 10308@cindex target attributes 10309@cindex machine attributes 10310@cindex attributes, target-specific 10311 10312Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types. 10313These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to 10314be documented in @file{extend.texi}. 10315 10316@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE 10317If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct 10318attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine 10319specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the 10320entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they 10321take. 10322@end deftypevr 10323 10324@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name}) 10325If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the 10326machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier 10327given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not 10328subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is 10329false for all machine-specific attributes. 10330@end deftypefn 10331 10332@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2}) 10333If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on 10334@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible, 10335and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be 10336generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are 10337supposed always to be compatible. 10338@end deftypefn 10339 10340@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type}) 10341If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to 10342the newly defined @var{type}. 10343@end deftypefn 10344 10345@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2}) 10346Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special 10347handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined 10348@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed 10349that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This 10350function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent 10351merging. 10352@end deftypefn 10353 10354@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl}) 10355Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special 10356handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined 10357@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}. 10358@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of 10359when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an 10360attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may 10361call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging. 10362 10363@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES 10364If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} 10365for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro 10366@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler 10367will then define a function called 10368@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as 10369the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also 10370add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port 10371to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and 10372@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and 10373@file{i386/i386.c}, for example. 10374@end deftypefn 10375 10376@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl}) 10377@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}. 10378@end deftypefn 10379 10380@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC 10381Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat 10382@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By 10383default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define 10384@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation 10385of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely 10386on this implementation detail. 10387@end defmac 10388 10389@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr}) 10390Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl 10391when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which 10392wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to 10393the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being 10394created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list 10395for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be 10396shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of 10397the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new 10398attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are 10399needed. 10400@end deftypefn 10401 10402@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl}) 10403@cindex inlining 10404This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl} 10405into the current function, despite its having target-specific 10406attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a 10407target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined. 10408@end deftypefn 10409 10410@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags}) 10411This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which 10412allows setting target-specific options on individual functions. 10413These function-specific options may differ 10414from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return 10415@code{true} if the options are valid. 10416 10417The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in 10418the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific 10419@code{struct cl_target_option} structure. 10420@end deftypefn 10421 10422@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts}) 10423This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information 10424in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific 10425options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure. 10426@xref{Option file format}. 10427@end deftypefn 10428 10429@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}) 10430This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific 10431information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for 10432function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure. 10433@end deftypefn 10434 10435@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}) 10436This hook is called to update target-specific information in the 10437@code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from 10438LTO bytecode. 10439@end deftypefn 10440 10441@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}) 10442This hook is called to print any additional target-specific 10443information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for 10444function-specific options. 10445@end deftypefn 10446 10447@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target}) 10448This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which 10449sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the 10450input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the 10451@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook. 10452@end deftypefn 10453 10454@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void) 10455Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on 10456a particular target machine. You can override the hook 10457@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called 10458once just after all the command options have been parsed. 10459 10460Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for 10461@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for. 10462 10463If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is 10464changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see 10465@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE} 10466@end deftypefn 10467 10468@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2}) 10469This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are 10470versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function 10471versions if and only if they have the same function signature and 10472different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for 10473different target machines. 10474@end deftypefn 10475 10476@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee}) 10477This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function 10478cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By 10479default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function 10480specific target options and the caller does not use the same options. 10481@end deftypefn 10482 10483@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}) 10484This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target. 10485@end deftypefn 10486 10487@node Emulated TLS 10488@section Emulating TLS 10489@cindex Emulated TLS 10490 10491For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via 10492specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is 10493used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be 10494configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance 10495the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation 10496layer. 10497 10498The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS 10499object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided 10500which, when given the address of the control object, will return the 10501address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object. 10502 10503@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS 10504Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control 10505object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's 10506emulated TLS helper function to be used. 10507@end deftypevr 10508 10509@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON 10510Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at 10511program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly 10512initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will 10513have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS 10514registration function to be used. 10515@end deftypevr 10516 10517@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION 10518Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should 10519be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in 10520any section. 10521@end deftypevr 10522 10523@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION 10524Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be 10525placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any 10526section. 10527@end deftypevr 10528 10529@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX 10530Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names. 10531The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix. 10532@end deftypevr 10533 10534@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX 10535Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The 10536default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix. 10537@end deftypevr 10538 10539@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name}) 10540Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control 10541object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and 10542@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of 10543@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable 10544for libgcc's emulated TLS function. 10545@end deftypefn 10546 10547@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr}) 10548Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a 10549TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl} 10550is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the 10551initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object. 10552@end deftypefn 10553 10554@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED 10555Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is 10556fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize 10557single objects. The default is false. 10558@end deftypevr 10559 10560@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS 10561Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor 10562may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects. 10563@end deftypevr 10564 10565@node MIPS Coprocessors 10566@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets. 10567@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros 10568 10569The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4 10570coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports 10571accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers 10572and memory using asm-ized variables. For example: 10573 10574@smallexample 10575 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1"); 10576 unsigned int d; 10577 10578 d = cp0count + 3; 10579@end smallexample 10580 10581(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate 10582names may be added as described below, or the default names may be 10583overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.) 10584 10585Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will 10586be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again 10587later in the function. 10588 10589Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is 10590the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips 10591floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism. 10592 10593@node PCH Target 10594@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking 10595@cindex parameters, precompiled headers 10596 10597@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz}) 10598This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by 10599@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets 10600@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes. 10601@end deftypefn 10602 10603@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz}) 10604This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are 10605compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL} 10606if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will 10607be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}. 10608 10609@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY} 10610when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes. 10611It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the 10612compiler, so no format checking is needed. 10613 10614The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be 10615suitable for most targets. 10616@end deftypefn 10617 10618@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags}) 10619If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of 10620@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values 10621of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that 10622@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return 10623value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}. 10624@end deftypefn 10625 10626@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void) 10627Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some 10628garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads, 10629it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need 10630to do anything here. 10631@end deftypefn 10632 10633@node C++ ABI 10634@section C++ ABI parameters 10635@cindex parameters, c++ abi 10636 10637@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void) 10638Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables. 10639These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The 10640default is long_long_integer_type_node. 10641@end deftypefn 10642 10643@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void) 10644This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return 10645@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of 10646@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used. 10647@end deftypefn 10648 10649@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type}) 10650This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array 10651whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already 10652known that a cookie is needed. The default is 10653@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the 10654IA64/Generic C++ ABI@. 10655@end deftypefn 10656 10657@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void) 10658This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in 10659array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}. 10660@end deftypefn 10661 10662@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export}) 10663If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export 10664class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export} 10665will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going 10666to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the 10667modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the 10668backend's targeted operating system. 10669@end deftypefn 10670 10671@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void) 10672This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return 10673the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return 10674@code{false}. 10675@end deftypefn 10676 10677@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void) 10678This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method 10679which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual 10680table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard 10681Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as 10682the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under 10683some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key 10684method. The default is to return @code{true}. 10685@end deftypefn 10686 10687@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}) 10688@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}. 10689@end deftypefn 10690 10691@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void) 10692This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other 10693similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have 10694external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for 10695classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation 10696unit will not be COMDAT. 10697@end deftypefn 10698 10699@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void) 10700This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for 10701the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always 10702be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT. 10703@end deftypefn 10704 10705@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void) 10706This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI) 10707should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit} 10708is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}. 10709@end deftypefn 10710 10711@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void) 10712This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used 10713in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static 10714destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in 10715shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are 10716unloaded. The default is to return false. 10717@end deftypefn 10718 10719@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type}) 10720@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications). 10721@end deftypefn 10722 10723@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl}) 10724Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}. 10725@end deftypefn 10726 10727@node D Language and ABI 10728@section D ABI parameters 10729@cindex parameters, d abi 10730 10731@deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS (void) 10732Declare all environmental version identifiers relating to the target CPU 10733using the function @code{builtin_version}, which takes a string representing 10734the name of the version. Version identifiers predefined by this hook apply 10735to all modules that are being compiled and imported. 10736@end deftypefn 10737 10738@deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_OS_VERSIONS (void) 10739Similarly to @code{TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS}, but is used for versions 10740relating to the target operating system. 10741@end deftypefn 10742 10743@deftypefn {D Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_D_CRITSEC_SIZE (void) 10744Returns the size of the data structure used by the target operating system 10745for critical sections and monitors. For example, on Microsoft Windows this 10746would return the @code{sizeof(CRITICAL_SECTION)}, while other platforms that 10747implement pthreads would return @code{sizeof(pthread_mutex_t)}. 10748@end deftypefn 10749 10750@node Named Address Spaces 10751@section Adding support for named address spaces 10752@cindex named address spaces 10753 10754The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275 10755standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to 10756support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded 10757processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a 10758GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for 10759address spaces other than the default address space. These address 10760spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and 10761@code{const} type attributes. 10762 10763Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than 10764pointers to the generic address space. 10765 10766For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer 10767to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU 10768processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves 10769issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the 10770local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea} 10771address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the 10772@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are 10773always 32 bits). 10774 10775Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the 10776range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic 10777address space. 10778 10779To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end, 10780the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example, 10781the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for 10782named address space #1: 10783@smallexample 10784#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1 10785c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA); 10786@end smallexample 10787 10788@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space}) 10789Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to 10790@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces. 10791The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}. 10792@end deftypefn 10793 10794@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space}) 10795Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in 10796@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces. 10797The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}. 10798@end deftypefn 10799 10800@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}) 10801Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers 10802with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target 10803hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook, 10804except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default 10805version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the 10806@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE} 10807target hooks for the given address space. 10808@end deftypefn 10809 10810@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as}) 10811Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode 10812@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict} 10813parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has 10814finished. This target hook is the same as the 10815@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes 10816explicit named address space support. 10817@end deftypefn 10818 10819@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}) 10820Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address 10821with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target 10822hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook, 10823except that it includes explicit named address space support. 10824@end deftypefn 10825 10826@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset}) 10827Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is 10828contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to 10829a named address space that is a subset of another named address space 10830will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in 10831arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be 10832converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts. 10833@end deftypefn 10834 10835@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as}) 10836Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the 10837address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address. 10838@end deftypefn 10839 10840@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type}) 10841Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL 10842@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address 10843space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points 10844to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is 10845guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other, 10846as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook. 10847@end deftypefn 10848 10849@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as}) 10850Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf. 10851The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}. 10852@end deftypefn 10853 10854@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc}) 10855Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on 10856command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the 10857address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows 10858to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space 10859was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is 10860the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. 10861@var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token. 10862The default implementation does nothing. 10863@end deftypefn 10864 10865@node Misc 10866@section Miscellaneous Parameters 10867@cindex parameters, miscellaneous 10868 10869@c prevent bad page break with this line 10870Here are several miscellaneous parameters. 10871 10872@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH 10873Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture 10874has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in 10875conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic 10876blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is 10877set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt 10878to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps. 10879@end defmac 10880 10881@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH 10882Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture 10883has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in 10884conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic 10885blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is 10886set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt 10887to cross between sections into indirect jumps. 10888@end defmac 10889 10890@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE 10891An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that 10892elements of a jump-table should have. 10893@end defmac 10894 10895@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body}) 10896Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec} 10897when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this, 10898it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}. 10899To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and 10900make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit. 10901The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale 10902flags can be updated. 10903@end defmac 10904 10905@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE 10906Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables 10907should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if 10908jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should 10909contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC} 10910is in effect. 10911@end defmac 10912 10913@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void) 10914This function return the smallest number of different values for which it 10915is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches. 10916The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and 10917five otherwise. This is best for most machines. 10918@end deftypefn 10919 10920@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS 10921Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode 10922smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register. To be 10923more explicit, if you start with a pair of @code{word_mode} registers with 10924known values and you do a subword, for example @code{QImode}, addition on 10925the low part of the registers, then the compiler may consider that the 10926result has a known value in @code{word_mode} too if the macro is defined 10927to 1. Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not. 10928@end defmac 10929 10930@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void) 10931On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also 10932maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit 10933arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers. 10934 10935On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try 10936using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead 10937of doing full 64-bit arithmetic. 10938 10939More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the 10940compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes 10941with a precision lower than the word precision. 10942 10943You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not 10944defined to 1. 10945@end deftypefn 10946 10947@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode}) 10948Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read 10949memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the 10950bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the 10951zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values 10952of @var{mem_mode} for which the 10953insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and 10954@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes. 10955 10956This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width 10957greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any 10958value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return 10959@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally 10960define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}. 10961 10962You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers 10963the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} 10964of these hard registers @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false 10965when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any 10966integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}. 10967 10968You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this 10969mode, @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to 10970@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that 10971is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}. 10972@end defmac 10973 10974@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND 10975Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign 10976extends. 10977@end defmac 10978 10979@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode}) 10980When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize 10981divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by 10982the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions 10983that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable 10984of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine 10985has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not. 10986@end deftypefn 10987 10988@defmac MOVE_MAX 10989The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly 10990between memory and registers or between two memory locations. 10991@end defmac 10992 10993@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX 10994The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly 10995between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this 10996is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the 10997constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have 10998at run-time. 10999@end defmac 11000 11001@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED 11002A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits 11003actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number 11004of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When 11005this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit 11006a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that 11007truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have 11008instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may 11009include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} 11010also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as 11011arguments to bit-field instructions. 11012 11013If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and 11014position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field 11015instructions exist, you should define this macro. 11016 11017However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation 11018only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended) 11019bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on 11020such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include 11021the implied truncation of the shift instructions. 11022 11023You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero. 11024@end defmac 11025 11026@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK} 11027@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode}) 11028This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode} 11029deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode. 11030@xref{shift patterns}. 11031 11032On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the 11033shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is 11034equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If 11035this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m}, 11036otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no 11037particular behavior is guaranteed. 11038 11039Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does 11040@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions 11041that are generated by the named shift patterns. 11042 11043The default implementation of this function returns 11044@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} 11045and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if 11046@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns 11047nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code 11048by overriding it. 11049@end deftypefn 11050 11051@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (poly_uint64 @var{outprec}, poly_uint64 @var{inprec}) 11052This hook returns true if it is safe to ``convert'' a value of 11053@var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec} bits (where @var{outprec} is 11054smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely operating on it as if it had only 11055@var{outprec} bits. The default returns true unconditionally, which 11056is correct for most machines. 11057 11058If @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P} returns false for a pair of modes, 11059suboptimal code can result if this hook returns true for the corresponding 11060mode sizes. Making this hook return false in such cases may improve things. 11061@end deftypefn 11062 11063@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, scalar_int_mode @var{rep_mode}) 11064The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values 11065are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return 11066@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in 11067sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN} 11068otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended 11069representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}, 11070@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either 11071@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends 11072@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next 11073widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.) 11074 11075Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} 11076value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers 11077as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers 11078@code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false. 11079 11080Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} 11081describe two related properties. If you define 11082@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want 11083to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of 11084extension. 11085 11086In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode}, 11087@code{TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to 11088@code{mode}. 11089@end deftypefn 11090 11091@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SETJMP_PRESERVES_NONVOLATILE_REGS_P (void) 11092On some targets, it is assumed that the compiler will spill all pseudos 11093 that are live across a call to @code{setjmp}, while other targets treat 11094 @code{setjmp} calls as normal function calls. 11095 11096 This hook returns false if @code{setjmp} calls do not preserve all 11097 non-volatile registers so that gcc that must spill all pseudos that are 11098 live across @code{setjmp} calls. Define this to return true if the 11099 target does not need to spill all pseudos live across @code{setjmp} calls. 11100 The default implementation conservatively assumes all pseudos must be 11101 spilled across @code{setjmp} calls. 11102@end deftypefn 11103 11104@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE 11105A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator 11106with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction 11107(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must 11108apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the 11109comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode. 11110 11111A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the 11112comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true 11113and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates 11114which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is 11115true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison 11116operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the 11117@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of 11118@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by 11119the compiler. 11120 11121If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will 11122generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also 11123replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause 11124the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined. 11125For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an 11126@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as 11127@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the 11128expression 11129 11130@smallexample 11131(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0)) 11132@end smallexample 11133 11134@noindent 11135can be converted to 11136 11137@smallexample 11138(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n})) 11139@end smallexample 11140 11141@noindent 11142where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being 11143tested into the sign bit. 11144 11145There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit 11146for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits, 11147but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you 11148are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to 11149perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the 11150comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}. 11151 11152Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value 11153from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the 11154choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions 11155to be used: 11156 11157@itemize @bullet 11158@item 11159Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for 11160@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to 11161``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the 11162comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to 11163combine the normalization with other operations. 11164 11165@item 11166For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being 11167slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on 11168other machines. 11169 11170@item 11171As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions 11172exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the 11173others. 11174 11175@item 11176Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}. 11177@end itemize 11178 11179Many machines can produce both the value chosen for 11180@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of 11181instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for 11182those cases, e.g., one matching 11183 11184@smallexample 11185(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C}))) 11186@end smallexample 11187 11188Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on 11189condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding 11190@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those 11191machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc} 11192and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform 11193@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See 11194@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to 11195find such instruction sequences on other machines. 11196 11197If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need 11198not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag 11199instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1. 11200@end defmac 11201 11202@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode}) 11203A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is 11204returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true. 11205Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return 11206floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define 11207this macro. 11208@end defmac 11209 11210@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode}) 11211A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element 11212for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner 11213mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define 11214this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that 11215return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define 11216this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or 11217@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent 11218the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the 11219given mode. 11220@end defmac 11221 11222@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value}) 11223@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value}) 11224A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value 11225for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand. 11226A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined. 11227If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should 11228evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab 11229entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into 11230the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}. 11231In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to 11232this value. 11233 11234If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or 11235@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined. 11236 11237This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs} 11238relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it 11239is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and 11240to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab. 11241 11242Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz} 11243and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions 11244visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will 11245to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of 11246breaking the API@. 11247@end defmac 11248 11249@defmac Pmode 11250An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define 11251this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware 11252pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines. 11253On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer 11254modes, such as @code{PSImode}. 11255 11256The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of 11257@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro 11258@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended 11259to @code{Pmode}. 11260@end defmac 11261 11262@defmac FUNCTION_MODE 11263An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions 11264being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines, 11265where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be 11266@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed 11267size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment 11268as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}. 11269@end defmac 11270 11271@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS 11272In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the 11273constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some 11274hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention, 11275where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies 11276strict conformance to the C Standard. 11277 11278Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host 11279convention when processing system header files, but when processing user 11280files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1. 11281@end defmac 11282 11283@deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void) 11284Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included. 11285 11286 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler. 11287@end deftypefn 11288 11289@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{}) 11290Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets. 11291@end deftypefn 11292 11293@defmac SYSTEM_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C 11294Define this macro if the system header files do not support C++@. 11295This macro handles system header files by pretending that system 11296header files are enclosed in @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}. 11297@end defmac 11298 11299@findex #pragma 11300@findex pragma 11301@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS () 11302Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas. 11303If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to 11304@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} 11305for each pragma. The macro may also do any 11306setup required for the pragmas. 11307 11308The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with 11309other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage 11310definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@. 11311 11312If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider 11313defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well. 11314 11315Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All 11316@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are 11317silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}. 11318@end defmac 11319 11320@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *)) 11321@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *)) 11322 11323Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or 11324@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The 11325@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a 11326pragma of the form 11327 11328@smallexample 11329#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{} 11330@end smallexample 11331 11332@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or 11333@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback 11334routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed 11335on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the 11336@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the 11337callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by 11338a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the 11339arguments of pragmas registered with 11340@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of 11341pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}. 11342 11343Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++ 11344compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any 11345other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going 11346to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when 11347building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the 11348variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the 11349target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name 11350the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the 11351code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a 11352rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows 11353how to build this object file. 11354@end deftypefun 11355 11356@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION 11357Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the 11358arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}. 11359@end defmac 11360 11361@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT 11362If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning 11363the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes). 11364This must be a value that would also be valid to use with 11365@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two). 11366@end defmac 11367 11368@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS 11369Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in 11370identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is 11371not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default; 11372there is no need to define this macro in that case. 11373@end defmac 11374 11375@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn}) 11376Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the 11377delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn}, 11378even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}. 11379@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that 11380every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn} 11381or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior, 11382you should define this macro. 11383 11384You need not define this macro if it would always return zero. 11385@end defmac 11386 11387@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn}) 11388Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the 11389delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn}, 11390even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}. 11391@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where 11392some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands 11393are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should 11394define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move 11395instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay 11396slot of @var{insn}. 11397 11398You need not define this macro if it would always return zero. 11399@end defmac 11400 11401@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES 11402Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases, 11403global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined 11404symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For 11405instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported 11406from shared libraries (DLLs). 11407 11408You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero. 11409@end defmac 11410 11411@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs}) 11412This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and 11413@var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically 11414clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected 11415to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm. 11416 11417It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints} 11418as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is 11419a sequence of insns to emit after the asm. 11420@end deftypefn 11421 11422@defmac MATH_LIBRARY 11423Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link 11424in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or 11425@samp{""} if the target does not have a 11426separate math library. 11427 11428You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong. 11429@end defmac 11430 11431@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV 11432Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that 11433specifies where the linker should look for libraries. 11434 11435You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"} 11436is wrong. 11437@end defmac 11438 11439@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO 11440Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file 11441functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@. 11442Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code 11443to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions 11444if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time 11445for cross-profiling. 11446@end defmac 11447 11448@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE 11449 11450A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via 11451conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of 11452@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and 114531 if it does use cc0. 11454@end defmac 11455 11456@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr}) 11457Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the 11458conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code. 11459@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which 11460contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr} 11461and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the 11462then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or 11463@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted. 11464@end defmac 11465 11466@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr}) 11467Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated 11468if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations. 11469@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently 11470being processed and about to be turned into a condition. 11471@end defmac 11472 11473@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn}) 11474A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to 11475be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to 11476a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information 11477about the currently processed blocks. 11478@end defmac 11479 11480@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info}) 11481A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in 11482converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks 11483can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed 11484to by @var{ce_info}. 11485@end defmac 11486 11487@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info}) 11488A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in 11489converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks 11490can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed 11491to by @var{ce_info}. 11492@end defmac 11493 11494@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info}) 11495A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion 11496of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed 11497to by @var{ce_info}. 11498@end defmac 11499 11500@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void) 11501If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the 11502instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels, 11503just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling. 11504 11505The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use 11506it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as 11507laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards. 11508Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations. 11509 11510You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default 11511definition is null. 11512@end deftypefn 11513 11514@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void) 11515Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions 11516that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the 11517necessary setup. 11518 11519Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine 11520instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because 11521they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector 11522instructions or prefetch instructions). 11523 11524To create a built-in function, call the function 11525@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function} 11526which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set 11527up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes}; 11528only language front ends that use those two functions will call 11529@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. 11530@end deftypefn 11531 11532@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p}) 11533Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions 11534that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the 11535builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}. 11536If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time 11537if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}. 11538If @var{code} is out of range the function should return 11539@code{error_mark_node}. 11540@end deftypefn 11541 11542@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore}) 11543 11544Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by 11545@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the 11546function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is 11547convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient. 11548@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of 11549@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be 11550ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the 11551built-in function. 11552@end deftypefn 11553 11554@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist}) 11555Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that 11556was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done 11557@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to 11558implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the 11559declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of 11560arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a 11561complete expression that implements the operation, usually 11562another @code{CALL_EXPR}. 11563@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*} 11564@end deftypefn 11565 11566@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore}) 11567Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by 11568@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the 11569built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to 11570the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}. 11571The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC, 11572containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If 11573@var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored. 11574@end deftypefn 11575 11576@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi}) 11577Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up 11578by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple 11579statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change 11580was made to the GIMPLE stream. 11581@end deftypefn 11582 11583@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2}) 11584This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to 11585determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used 11586during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two 11587versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority 11588is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are 11589 the two function decls that will be compared. 11590@end deftypefn 11591 11592@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl}) 11593This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function 11594versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function 11595version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically 11596identical versions. 11597@end deftypefn 11598 11599@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg}) 11600This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right 11601function version at run-time for a given set of function versions. 11602@var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose 11603body must be generated. 11604@end deftypefn 11605 11606@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top}) 11607Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end} 11608and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the 11609exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives 11610the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is 11611the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that 11612contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the 11613loop is only entered from the top. 11614 11615This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default 11616implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost} 11617if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions. 11618@end deftypefn 11619 11620@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn}) 11621 11622Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a 11623low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop 11624could not be applied. 11625 11626Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any 11627instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating 11628the reason why the doloop could not be applied. 11629By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for 11630loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions. 11631@end deftypefn 11632 11633@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}) 11634Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions. 11635@end deftypefn 11636 11637@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee}) 11638FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning. 11639@end deftypefn 11640 11641@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code}) 11642This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative. 11643Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider 11644PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code 11645of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN. 11646@end deftypefn 11647 11648@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg}) 11649 11650When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo 11651register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register 11652to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot 11653it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE} 11654is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register 11655that had its initial value copied by using 11656@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}. 11657Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want 11658to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be 11659the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a 11660@code{MEM}. 11661If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator; 11662it might decide to use another register anyways. 11663You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or 11664@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard 11665register in question will not be clobbered. 11666The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special 11667allocation. 11668@end deftypefn 11669 11670@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags}) 11671This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or 11672@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use 11673this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and 11674@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1} 11675to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be 11676passed along. 11677@end deftypefn 11678 11679@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl}) 11680The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function 11681context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if 11682the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a 11683per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function 11684attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns. 11685The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context, 11686and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context 11687and is returning to processing at the top level. 11688The default hook function does nothing. 11689 11690GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of 11691some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this 11692situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively, 11693or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state. 11694@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level, 11695outside of any function scope. 11696@end deftypefn 11697 11698@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX 11699Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object 11700files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will 11701use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files. 11702@end defmac 11703 11704@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX 11705Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be 11706automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you 11707do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for 11708executable files. 11709@end defmac 11710 11711@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST 11712If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files 11713specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker. 11714Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards 11715object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export 11716lists. 11717@end defmac 11718 11719@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl}) 11720Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the 11721method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods 11722must be invoked differently from other methods on your target. 11723For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using 11724the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then 11725defined as this expression: 11726 11727@smallexample 11728build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl}, 11729 build_tree_list 11730 (get_identifier ("stdcall"), 11731 NULL)) 11732@end smallexample 11733@end defmac 11734 11735@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void) 11736This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump 11737instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for 11738every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be 11739reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as: 11740 11741@smallexample 11742static bool 11743cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p () 11744@{ 11745 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress); 11746@} 11747@end smallexample 11748@end deftypefn 11749 11750@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void) 11751This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register 11752optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be 11753usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be 11754re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected 11755to inter-block scheduling. 11756@end deftypefn 11757 11758@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen}) 11759Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved 11760registers 11761that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook 11762returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure 11763that all target registers in the class returned by 11764@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are 11765saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and 11766epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return 11767true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely 11768to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} 11769to reserve space for caller-saved target registers. 11770@end deftypefn 11771 11772@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void) 11773This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution. 11774This target hook is required only when the target has several different 11775modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM. 11776@end deftypefn 11777 11778@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}) 11779This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a 11780 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison 11781 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. 11782 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare 11783 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the 11784 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error. 11785 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}. 11786@end deftypefn 11787 11788@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code}) 11789This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence 11790 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with 11791 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. 11792 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare 11793 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the 11794 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The 11795 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first} 11796 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of 11797 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must 11798 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. 11799 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}. 11800 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares. 11801@end deftypefn 11802 11803@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop}) 11804This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop} 11805should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times 11806the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to 11807the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook 11808is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum 11809number of memory accesses. 11810@end deftypefn 11811 11812@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS 11813If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression 11814that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications 11815that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer 11816constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring 11817more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the 11818system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines. 11819The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count. 11820@end defmac 11821 11822@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc}) 11823This target hook should register any extra include files for the 11824target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files 11825are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. 11826The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory. 11827@end deftypefn 11828 11829@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc}) 11830This target hook should register any extra include files for the 11831target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc} 11832indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter 11833@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter 11834@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory. 11835@end deftypefn 11836 11837@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path}) 11838This target hook should register special include paths for the target. 11839The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin 11840systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics 11841that are different from @option{-I}. 11842@end deftypefn 11843 11844@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl}) 11845This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias 11846for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks, 11847@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all 11848functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines 11849@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise, 11850@end defmac 11851 11852@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES 11853If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing 11854target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat} 11855option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks. 11856@end defmac 11857 11858@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES 11859If defined, this macro is the number of entries in 11860@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}. 11861@end defmac 11862 11863@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES 11864If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing 11865target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The 11866default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined, 11867@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too. 11868@end defmac 11869 11870@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT 11871If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in 11872@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}. 11873@end defmac 11874 11875@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT 11876If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization 11877routine for target specific customizations of the system printf 11878and scanf formatter settings. 11879@end defmac 11880 11881@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val}) 11882If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is 11883illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl} 11884with prototype @var{typelist}. 11885@end deftypefn 11886 11887@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype}) 11888If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is 11889invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL} 11890if validity should be determined by the front end. 11891@end deftypefn 11892 11893@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type}) 11894If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is 11895invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by 11896@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL} 11897if validity should be determined by the front end. 11898@end deftypefn 11899 11900@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2}) 11901If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is 11902invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1} 11903and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by 11904the front end. 11905@end deftypefn 11906 11907@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type}) 11908If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of 11909@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions, 11910analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the 11911front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are 11912target-specific types with special promotion rules. 11913This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends. 11914@end deftypefn 11915 11916@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr}) 11917If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to 11918@var{type}. It should return the converted expression, 11919or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules. 11920This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special 11921conversion rules. 11922This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends. 11923@end deftypefn 11924 11925@defmac OBJC_JBLEN 11926This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the 11927NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value. 11928@end defmac 11929 11930@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE 11931Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached 11932to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for 11933call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h} 11934and the associated definitions of those functions. 11935@end defmac 11936 11937@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void) 11938Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if 11939necessary. 11940@end deftypefn 11941 11942@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void) 11943This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a 11944different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's 11945argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP 11946is needed. 11947@end deftypefn 11948 11949@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void) 11950When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not 11951arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates 11952stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make 11953debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with 11954@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler 11955cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed 11956to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but 11957false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true. 11958@end deftypefn 11959 11960@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR 11961On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize 11962a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that 11963is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant 11964is computed from this register using immediate addition or 11965subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of 11966the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the 11967available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new 11968constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and 11969down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}. 11970@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value 11971accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the 11972value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on 11973MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value, 11974@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value 11975is zero, which disables this optimization. 11976@end deftypevr 11977 11978@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void) 11979Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding 11980Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not 11981supported by the target. 11982@end deftypefn 11983 11984@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val}) 11985Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific 11986memory model bits are allowed. 11987@end deftypefn 11988 11989@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL 11990This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e.@: the @code{bool} @code{true}. 11991@end deftypevr 11992 11993@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void) 11994It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions. 11995The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker. 11996The default value of this hook is based on target's libc. 11997@end deftypefn 11998 11999@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}) 12000If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used. 12001@end deftypefn 12002 12003@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update}) 12004ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}. 12005@end deftypefn 12006 12007@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree) 12008Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named 12009sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be 12010recorded in the offload function and variable table. 12011@end deftypefn 12012 12013@deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void) 12014Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should 12015translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use) 12016into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface 12017to express such options. It should return a string containing these options, 12018separated by spaces, which the caller will free. 12019 12020@end deftypefn 12021 12022@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT 12023 12024On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl 12025objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero 12026to indicate that large integers are stored in 12027@code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows 12028very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE} 12029is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT} 12030representation. 12031 12032Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where 12033@code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that 12034code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i 12035const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that 12036need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look. 12037 12038@itemize @bullet 12039@item 12040There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for 12041@code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md 12042language since there are a variable number of elements. 12043 12044Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the 12045value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary 12046since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there 12047are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap 12048instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code. 12049However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C 12050code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is 12051not really a large change. 12052 12053@item 12054Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize 12055constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each 12056port in this code. 12057 12058@item 12059The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger 12060constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}. 12061@end itemize 12062 12063All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the 12064maintainer is familiar with. 12065 12066@end defmac 12067 12068@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (bool @var{active}) 12069This hook is used to determine the level of target support for 12070 @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value}. If called with an argument 12071 of false, it returns true if the target has been modified to support 12072 this builtin. If called with an argument of true, it returns true 12073 if the target requires active mitigation execution might be speculative. 12074 12075 The default implementation returns false if the target does not define 12076 a pattern named @code{speculation_barrier}. Else it returns true 12077 for the first case and whether the pattern is enabled for the current 12078 compilation for the second case. 12079 12080 For targets that have no processors that can execute instructions 12081 speculatively an alternative implemenation of this hook is available: 12082 simply redefine this hook to @code{speculation_safe_value_not_needed} 12083 along with your other target hooks. 12084@end deftypefn 12085 12086@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{result}, rtx @var{val}, rtx @var{failval}) 12087This target hook can be used to generate a target-specific code 12088 sequence that implements the @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value} 12089 built-in function. The function must always return @var{val} in 12090 @var{result} in mode @var{mode} when the cpu is not executing 12091 speculatively, but must never return that when speculating until it 12092 is known that the speculation will not be unwound. The hook supports 12093 two primary mechanisms for implementing the requirements. The first 12094 is to emit a speculation barrier which forces the processor to wait 12095 until all prior speculative operations have been resolved; the second 12096 is to use a target-specific mechanism that can track the speculation 12097 state and to return @var{failval} if it can determine that 12098 speculation must be unwound at a later time. 12099 12100 The default implementation simply copies @var{val} to @var{result} and 12101 emits a @code{speculation_barrier} instruction if that is defined. 12102@end deftypefn 12103 12104@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void) 12105If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target. 12106@end deftypefn 12107